ff5593d8e697b2f8d4011848a00395a108c94238
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @end itemize
491
492 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
493 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
494 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
495 @itemize @bullet
496 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
497 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
498 @end itemize
499
500 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
501 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
502 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
503 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
504
505 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
506 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
507 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
508
509 @section USB Other
510 @itemize @bullet
511 @item @b{USBprog}
512 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
513
514 @item @b{USB - Presto}
515 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
516
517 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
518 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
519
520 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
522
523 @item @b{Buspirate}
524 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
525
526 @item @b{opendous}
527 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
528
529 @item @b{estick}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
531
532 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
533 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
534 @end itemize
535
536 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
537
538 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
539 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
540 these on the market.
541
542 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
543 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
544 of USB-based ones.
545
546 @itemize @bullet
547
548 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
549 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
550
551 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
552 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
553 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
554
555 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
556 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
557
558 @item @b{Wiggler2}
559 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
562 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
563
564 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
565 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
566
567 @item @b{arm-jtag}
568 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
569
570 @item @b{chameleon}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Triton}
574 @* Unknown.
575
576 @item @b{Lattice}
577 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
578 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
579
580 @item @b{flashlink}
581 @* From ST Microsystems;
582 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
583
584 @end itemize
585
586 @section Other...
587 @itemize @bullet
588
589 @item @b{ep93xx}
590 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
591
592 @item @b{at91rm9200}
593 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
594
595 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
596 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
597
598 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
599 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
600 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
601
602 @end itemize
603
604 @node About Jim-Tcl
605 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
606 @cindex Jim-Tcl
607 @cindex tcl
608
609 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
610 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
611 command interpreter.
612
613 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
614 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
615 much of anything about Tcl.
616 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
617
618 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
619 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
620 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
621 OpenOCD mailing list.
622
623 @itemize @bullet
624 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
625 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
626 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
627 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
628 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
629 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
630
631 @item @b{Missing Features}
632 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
633 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
634 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
635 enabled in OpenOCD.
636
637 @item @b{Scripts}
638 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
639 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
640 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
641
642 @item @b{Commands}
643 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
644 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
645 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
646 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
647
648 @item @b{Historical Note}
649 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
650 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
651 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
652 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
653
654 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
655 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
656 @end itemize
657
658 @node Running
659 @chapter Running
660 @cindex command line options
661 @cindex logfile
662 @cindex directory search
663
664 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
665 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
666 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
667 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
668 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
669 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
670 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
671
672 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
673 tell it how each debug session should work.
674 The @option{--help} option shows:
675 @verbatim
676 bash$ openocd --help
677
678 --help | -h display this help
679 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
680 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
681 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
682 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
683 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
684 --command | -c run <command>
685 @end verbatim
686
687 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
688 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
689 To specify one or more different
690 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
691
692 @example
693 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
694 @end example
695
696 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
697 @enumerate
698 @item the current directory,
699 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
700 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
701 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
702 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
703 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
704 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
705 @end enumerate
706 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
707
708 @quotation Note
709 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
710 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
711 @end quotation
712
713 @section Simple setup, no customization
714
715 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
716 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
717 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
718 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
719 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
720
721 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
722 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
723 the server with some variation of one of the following:
724
725 @example
726 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
727 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 @end example
729
730 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
731 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
732 If all goes well you'll see output something like
733
734 @example
735 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
736 For bug reports, read
737 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
738 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
739 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
740 @end example
741
742 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
743 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
744 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
745
746 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
747
748 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
749 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
750 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
751 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
752 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
753 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
754 ensure that this always succeeds.
755 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
756 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
757 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
758 and then shut down without acting as a server.
759
760 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
761 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
762 those channels.
763
764 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
765 the @option{-d} option.
766
767 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
768 @option{-c} command line switch.
769
770 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
771 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
772 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
773 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
774 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
775 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
776 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
777
778 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
779 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
780
781 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
782 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
783 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
784 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
785
786 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
787 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
788
789 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
790 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
791 and start the OpenOCD server.
792 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
793 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
794 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
795 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
796
797 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
798
799 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
800 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
801 and a USB cable on the other.
802 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
803 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
804
805 @enumerate
806 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
807 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
808 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
809 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
810 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
811 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
812 debugging host.
813
814 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
815 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
816 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
817 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
818 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
819
820 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
821 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
822 with 1.2 Volt boards.
823
824 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
825 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
826 ways to connect the cable.
827 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
828 Be sure it's firmly connected.
829
830 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
831 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
832 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
833 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
834 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
835 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
836 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
837 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
838
839 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
840 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
841 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
842 but are tedious to set up.
843 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
844 adapter signals to the right board pins.
845
846 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
847 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
848 you are using to run OpenOCD.
849 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
850
851 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
852 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
853 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
854 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
855
856 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
857 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
858 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
859
860 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
861 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
862 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
863 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
864
865 @end enumerate
866
867 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
868 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
869 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
870
871 @section Project Directory
872
873 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
874
875 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
876 single directory for your work with a given board.
877 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
878 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
879 files accessed through semihosting,
880 and for code you upload to the target board.
881 It is also the natural place to write files,
882 such as log files and data you download from the board.
883
884 @section Configuration Basics
885
886 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
887 a variety of ways you can mix them.
888 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
889
890 @itemize
891 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
892 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
893 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
894 @end itemize
895
896 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
897 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
898 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
899
900 @example
901 source [find interface/signalyzer.cfg]
902
903 # GDB can also flash my flash!
904 gdb_memory_map enable
905 gdb_flash_program enable
906
907 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
908 @end example
909
910 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
911
912 @example
913 openocd -f interface/signalyzer.cfg \
914 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
915 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
916 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
917 @end example
918
919 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
920 each supporting a different development task.
921 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
922 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
923
924 @quotation Important
925 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
926 problems with how it treats variables.
927 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
928 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
929 that can be tested in a later script.
930 @end quotation
931
932 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
933 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
934 to simplify your work.
935
936 @section User Config Files
937 @cindex config file, user
938 @cindex user config file
939 @cindex config file, overview
940
941 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
942 in one place.
943 One of the following will match your situation best:
944
945 @itemize
946 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
947 provided by someone else.
948 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
949 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
950 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
951 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
952 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
953 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
954
955 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
956 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
957
958 @enumerate
959 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
960 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
961 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
962 @end enumerate
963
964 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
965 The first is an interface config file.
966 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
967 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
968 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
969 meet your deadline:
970
971 @example
972 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
973 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
974 @end example
975
976 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
977 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
978 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
979 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
980
981 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
982 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
983 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
984 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
985 target and board
986 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
987 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
988
989 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
990 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
991 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
992 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
993
994 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
995 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
996 giving access to your particular flash chips.
997 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
998 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
999
1000 @quotation Note
1001 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1002 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1003 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1004 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1005 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1006 @end quotation
1007
1008 @item
1009 You may may need to write some C code.
1010 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1011 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1012 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1013 a new chip architecture.
1014 @end itemize
1015
1016 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1017 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1018 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1019
1020 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1021 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1022 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1023 @itemize
1024
1025 @item
1026 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1027 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1028 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1029 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1030
1031 @item
1032 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1033 @cindex vector_catch
1034 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1035 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1036 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1037 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1038 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1039 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1040
1041 @item
1042 You might need to override some defaults.
1043 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1044 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1045
1046 @item
1047 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1048 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1049 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1050 @end itemize
1051
1052 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1053
1054 A few project-specific utility
1055 routines may well speed up your work.
1056 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1057
1058 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1059 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1060 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1061 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1062 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1063 may help:
1064
1065 @example
1066 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1067 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1068 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1069 # Leave the CPU halted.
1070 reset init
1071
1072 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1073 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1074
1075 # Start running.
1076 resume 0x20000000
1077 @}
1078 @end example
1079
1080 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1081 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1082 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1083 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1084 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1085
1086 @example
1087 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1088 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1089 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1090 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1091 reset init
1092
1093 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1094 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1095 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1096 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1097 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1098 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1099 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1100
1101 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1102 reset run
1103 @}
1104 @end example
1105
1106 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1107 from NAND.
1108 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1109 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1110 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1111
1112 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1113 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1114
1115 @section Target Software Changes
1116
1117 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1118 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1119 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1120 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1121 handling issues like:
1122
1123 @itemize @bullet
1124
1125 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1126 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1127 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1128 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1129 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1130 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1131 your debug sessions.
1132
1133 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1134 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1135 That might however be your only option.
1136
1137 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1138 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1139 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1140 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1141 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1142 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1143 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1144 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1145 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1146 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1147 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1148 instead of the whole thing.
1149 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1150 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1151
1152 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1153 @cindex ARM semihosting
1154 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1155 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1156 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1157 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1158 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1159 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1160 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1161 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1162 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1163 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1164 NAND or SPI flash.
1165
1166 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1167 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1168 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1169 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1170 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1171
1172 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1173 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1174 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1175 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1176 registers which can be used to change various features including
1177 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1178 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1179 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1180 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1181 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1182
1183 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1184 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1185 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1186 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1187 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1188
1189 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1190 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1191 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1192 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1193 early code execution can be debugged
1194 or firmware can be replaced.
1195
1196 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1197 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1198 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1199 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1200 operations like writing to memory.)
1201
1202 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1203 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1204 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1205 various kinds of message.
1206 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1207
1208 @end itemize
1209
1210 @section Target Hardware Setup
1211
1212 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1213 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1214 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1215 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1216 working with.}
1217
1218 Common issues include:
1219
1220 @itemize @bullet
1221
1222 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1223 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1224 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1225 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1226 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1227 or one from a daughtercard).
1228 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1229 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1230
1231 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1232 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1233 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1234 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1235 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1236 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1237
1238 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1239 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1240 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1241 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1242 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1243
1244
1245 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1246 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1247 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1248 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1249 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1250 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1251 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1252
1253 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1254 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1255 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1256 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1257 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1258
1259 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1260 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1261 used to start booting.
1262
1263 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1264 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1265 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1266 multiple audio codec chips).
1267 This interacts with software
1268 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1269 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1270 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1271 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1272 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1273 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1274 audio or video codecs are used.
1275
1276 @end itemize
1277
1278 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1279 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1280 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1281 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1282 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1283 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1284 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1285 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1286 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1287 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1288
1289
1290 @node Config File Guidelines
1291 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1292
1293 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1294 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1295 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1296 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1297
1298 You should find the following directories under
1299 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1300 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1301 @itemize @bullet
1302 @item @file{interface} ...
1303 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1304 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1305 @item @file{board} ...
1306 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1307 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1308
1309 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1310 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1311 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1312 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1313 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1314 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1315 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1316 a CPU and an FPGA.
1317 @item @file{target} ...
1318 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1319 on a chip
1320 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1321 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1322 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1323 the target config file defines all of them.
1324 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1325 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1326 @end itemize
1327
1328 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1329 file may override features in any of the above files by
1330 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1331 commands specific to their situation.
1332
1333 @section Interface Config Files
1334
1335 The user config file
1336 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1337
1338 @example
1339 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1340 @end example
1341
1342 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1343 in use today with OpenOCD.
1344 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1345 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1346
1347 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1348 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1349 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1350 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1351 and need to provide a driver for it.
1352
1353 @section Board Config Files
1354 @cindex config file, board
1355 @cindex board config file
1356
1357 The user config file
1358 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1359
1360 @example
1361 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1362 @end example
1363
1364 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1365 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1366 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1367
1368 @enumerate
1369 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1370 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1371 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1372 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1373 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1374 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1375 @end enumerate
1376
1377 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1378 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1379 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1380 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1381
1382 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1383 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1384 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1385 configuration works.
1386
1387 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1388
1389 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1390 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1391 convention on how to use certain variables.
1392
1393 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1394 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1395 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1396 used at will within a target configuration file.
1397
1398 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1399 for a board with three chips:
1400
1401 @example
1402 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1403 set CHIPNAME network
1404 set ENDIAN big
1405 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1406 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1407 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1408 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1409
1410 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1411 set CHIPNAME video
1412 set ENDIAN little
1413 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1414 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1415 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1416 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1417
1418 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1419 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1420 unset ENDIAN
1421 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1422 @end example
1423
1424 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1425 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1426 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1427 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1428 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1429 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1430 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1431 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1432
1433 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1434 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1435 naming collisions.
1436
1437 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1438 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1439 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1440 up other clocks and peripherals.
1441
1442 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1443 @cindex variable names
1444
1445 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1446 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1447 one such chip (as shown above).
1448 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1449 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1450 to promote consistency and
1451 so that board files can override target defaults.
1452
1453 Inputs to target config files include:
1454
1455 @itemize @bullet
1456 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1457 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1458 tap identifier dotted names.
1459 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1460 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1461 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1462 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1463 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1464 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1465 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1466 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1467 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1468 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1469 @end itemize
1470
1471 Outputs from target config files include:
1472
1473 @itemize @bullet
1474 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1475 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1476 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1477 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1478 specific to that board and that target.
1479 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1480 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1481 @end itemize
1482
1483 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1484 @cindex event, reset-init
1485 @cindex reset-init handler
1486
1487 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1488 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1489 fully set up yet.
1490 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1491 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1492 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1493 handler is one of the most important.
1494
1495 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1496 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1497 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1498 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1499 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1500
1501 @quotation Note
1502 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1503 are included here.
1504 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1505 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1506 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1507 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1508 @end quotation
1509
1510 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1511 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1512 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1513 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1514 those as parameters.
1515 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1516 and disabling the watchdog.
1517 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1518 the next developer doing such work.
1519 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1520
1521 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1522 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1523 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1524 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1525
1526 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1527
1528 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1529 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1530 a low JTAG clock rate.
1531 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1532 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1533 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1534 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1535 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1536 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1537 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1538
1539 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1540 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1541 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1542 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1543 which might be less than that.
1544
1545 @quotation Warning
1546 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1547 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1548 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1549 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1550 @end quotation
1551
1552 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1553 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1554 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1555 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1556 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1557 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1558
1559 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1560 @subsection The init_board procedure
1561 @cindex init_board procedure
1562
1563 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1564 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1565 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1566 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1567 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1568 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1569 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1570 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1571 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1572 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1573 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1574 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1575
1576 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1577 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1578
1579 @example
1580 ### board_file.cfg ###
1581
1582 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1583 source [find target/target.cfg]
1584
1585 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1586 # enables fast on-board clock source
1587 # configures the chip to use it
1588 @}
1589
1590 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1591 proc init_board @{@} @{
1592 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1593
1594 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1595 adapter_khz 1
1596 enable_fast_clock
1597 adapter_khz 10000
1598 @}
1599 @}
1600 @end example
1601
1602 @section Target Config Files
1603 @cindex config file, target
1604 @cindex target config file
1605
1606 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1607 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1608 more target config files like this:
1609
1610 @example
1611 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1612 @end example
1613
1614 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1615 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1616 In summary the target files should contain
1617
1618 @enumerate
1619 @item Set defaults
1620 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1621 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1622 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1623 @item On-Chip flash
1624 @end enumerate
1625
1626 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1627 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1628 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1629
1630 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1631 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1632 can talk to the chip.
1633 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1634 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1635 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1636 and other processing engines.
1637
1638 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1639
1640 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1641 letting board config files express environment-specific
1642 differences in how things should be set up.
1643
1644 @example
1645 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1646 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1647 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1648 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1649 @} else @{
1650 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1651 @}
1652
1653 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1654 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1655 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1656 @} else @{
1657 set _ENDIAN little
1658 @}
1659
1660 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1661 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1662 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1663 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1664 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1665 @} else @{
1666 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1667 @}
1668 @end example
1669 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1670
1671 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1672 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1673 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1674
1675 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1676 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1677 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1678
1679 @example
1680 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1681 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1682 @end example
1683
1684 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1685 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1686 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1687 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1688 for taps.
1689
1690 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1691 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1692 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1693 looks (in part) like this:
1694
1695 @example
1696 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1697 @end example
1698
1699 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1700 to source such a config file twice, with different
1701 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1702 it adds a different TAP each time.
1703
1704 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1705 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1706 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1707 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1708
1709 @example
1710 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1711 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1712 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1713 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1714 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1715 @end example
1716
1717 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1718 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1719
1720 @itemize
1721 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1722 plus a JRC to enable them
1723 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1724 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1725 is not currently used)
1726 @end itemize
1727
1728 @subsection Add CPU targets
1729
1730 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1731 GDB and other commands can use it.
1732 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1733 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1734 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1735 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1736
1737 @example
1738 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1739 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1740 @end example
1741
1742 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1743 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1744 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1745 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1746 a work area if you can.
1747 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1748
1749 @example
1750 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1751 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1752 @end example
1753
1754 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1755 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1756 @cindex SMP
1757 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1761 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1762 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1763 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1764 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1765 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1766 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1767 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1768 @end example
1769 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1770 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1771 @itemize @bullet
1772 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1773 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1774 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1775 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1776 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1777 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1778 @end itemize
1779
1780 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1781 command have been implemented.
1782 @itemize @bullet
1783 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1784 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1785 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1786 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1787 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1788 following example.
1789 @end itemize
1790
1791 @example
1792 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1793 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1794 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1795 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1796 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1797 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1798 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1799 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1800 > resume
1801 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1802 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1803 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1804 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1805 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1806 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1807 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1808 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 @end example
1810
1811
1812 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1813
1814 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1815 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1816 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1817
1818 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1819 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1820 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1821 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1822 both signals.
1823
1824 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1825 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1826 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1827 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1828 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1829 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1830 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1831 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1832 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1833 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1834 not available.)
1835
1836 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1837 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1838 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1839 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1840 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1841 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1842 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1843 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1844
1845 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1846 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1847 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1848 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1849 slower clock than they will use later.
1850 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1851 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1852 than they will use later.
1853 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1854
1855 @quotation Important
1856 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1857 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1858 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1859 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1860 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1861 @end quotation
1862
1863 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1864 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1865 @cindex init_targets procedure
1866
1867 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1868 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1869 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1870 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1871 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1872 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1873 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1874 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1875 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1876
1877 @example
1878 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1879
1880 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1881 # basic initialization procedure ...
1882 @}
1883
1884 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1885 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1886 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1887 @}
1888
1889 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1890
1891 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1892
1893 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1894 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1895 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1896 @}
1897 @end example
1898
1899 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1900 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1901
1902 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1903
1904 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1905 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1906
1907 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1908 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1909 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1910
1911 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1912 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1913 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1914 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1915 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1916 events already assigned.
1917
1918 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1919
1920 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1921 special high speed download features - enable it.
1922
1923 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1924
1925 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1926 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1927 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1928 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1929 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1930 If you are using an external trace port,
1931 configure it in your board config file.
1932 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1933 configure it in your target config file.
1934
1935 @example
1936 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1937 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1938 @end example
1939
1940 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1941
1942 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1943
1944 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1945 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1946 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1947 the TARGET (chip) file.
1948
1949 Examples:
1950 @itemize @bullet
1951 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1952 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1953 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1954 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1955 @end itemize
1956
1957 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1958 @section Translating Configuration Files
1959 @cindex translation
1960 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1961 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1962 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1963 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1964 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1965 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1966
1967 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1968 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1969 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1970 convert other scripts later on.
1971
1972 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1973 replace job:
1974
1975 @example
1976 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1977 #
1978 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1979 #
1980 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1981 #
1982 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1983
1984 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1985 global TARGETNAME
1986
1987 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1988
1989 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1990 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1991 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1992 @}
1993 @end example
1994
1995
1996
1997 @node Server Configuration
1998 @chapter Server Configuration
1999 @cindex initialization
2000 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2001 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2002 supported.
2003
2004 @anchor{configurationstage}
2005 @section Configuration Stage
2006 @cindex configuration stage
2007 @cindex config command
2008
2009 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2010 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2011 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2012 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2013 inside startup scripts.
2014
2015 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2016 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2017 which may be issued interactively.
2018 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2019 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2020
2021 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2022 flash banks,
2023 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2024 and other basic setup.
2025 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2026 may access or activate TAPs.
2027 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2028 longer be issued.
2029
2030 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2031 @section Entering the Run Stage
2032
2033 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2034 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2035 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2036 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2037 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2038 You should see no errors at this point.
2039 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2040 commands you used to configure the server.
2041 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2042 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2043 on the scan chain.
2044
2045 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2046 become available.
2047 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2048 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2049 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2050 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2051 entry to the run stage.
2052
2053 @deffn {Config Command} init
2054 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2055 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2056 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2057 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2058 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2059 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2060
2061 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2062 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2063 configuration files and/or command line options.
2064
2065 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2066 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2067 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2068 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2069 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2070 @end deffn
2071
2072 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2073 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2074 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075
2076 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2077 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2078 scan chain.
2079 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2080 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2081
2082 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2083 they return.
2084 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2085 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2086 @end deffn
2087
2088 @anchor{tcpipports}
2089 @section TCP/IP Ports
2090 @cindex TCP port
2091 @cindex server
2092 @cindex port
2093 @cindex security
2094 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2095 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2096 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2097
2098 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2099 access using one or more of these ports.
2100 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2101 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2102 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2103
2104 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2105 @cindex GDB server
2106 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2107 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2108 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2109 the normal use cases.
2110
2111 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2112 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2113 disables the gdb server.
2114
2115 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2116 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2117
2118 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2119 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2120
2121 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2122 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2123 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2124
2125 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2126 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2127 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2128 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2129
2130 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2131 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2132 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2133
2134 @end deffn
2135
2136 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2137 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2138 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2139 output from the Tcl engine.
2140 Intended as a machine interface.
2141 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2142 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2143 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2144 @end deffn
2145
2146 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2147 Specify or query the
2148 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2149 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2150 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2151 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2152 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2153 @end deffn
2154
2155 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2156 @section GDB Configuration
2157 @cindex GDB
2158 @cindex GDB configuration
2159 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2160 The ones listed here are static and global.
2161 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2162 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2163
2164 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2165 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2166 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2167 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2168 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2169 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2170 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2174 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2175 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2176 vFlash packet is received.
2177 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2178 @end deffn
2179
2180 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2181 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2182 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2183 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2184 for flash programming to work.
2185 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2186 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2187 @end deffn
2188
2189 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2191 by GDB memory read packets.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2193 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2197 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2198 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2199 @end deffn
2200
2201 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2202 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2203
2204 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2205 @end deffn
2206
2207 @anchor{eventpolling}
2208 @section Event Polling
2209
2210 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2211 where significant events can happen at any time.
2212 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2213 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2214 or to GDB.
2215
2216 Examples of such events include:
2217
2218 @itemize
2219 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2220 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2221 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2222 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2223 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2224 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2225 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2226 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2227 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2228 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2229 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2230 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2231 @end itemize
2232
2233 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2234 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2235 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2236 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2237 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2238
2239 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2240 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2241 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2242 to the various active targets.
2243 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2244 which is normally done in the background.
2245
2246 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2247 Poll the current target for its current state.
2248 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2249 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2250 specific information about the current state is printed.
2251 An optional parameter
2252 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2253
2254 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2255 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2256 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2257 @example
2258 > poll
2259 background polling: on
2260 target state: halted
2261 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2262 current mode: Supervisor
2263 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2264 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2265 >
2266 @end example
2267 @end deffn
2268
2269 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2270 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2271 @cindex config file, interface
2272 @cindex interface config file
2273
2274 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2275 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2276 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2277
2278 @quotation Note
2279 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2280 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2281 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2282 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2283 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2284 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2285 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2286 @end quotation
2287
2288 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2289 through commands in an interface configuration
2290 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2291 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2292
2293 @example
2294 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2295 @end example
2296
2297 These commands tell
2298 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2299 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2300
2301 @example
2302 # jlink interface
2303 interface jlink
2304 @end example
2305
2306 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2307
2308
2309 @section Interface Configuration
2310
2311 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2312 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2313 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2314
2315 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2316 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2317 target.
2318 @end deffn
2319
2320 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2321 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2322 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2323 @end deffn
2324 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2325 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2326 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2327 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2328 the hardware can support.
2329 @end deffn
2330
2331
2332
2333 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2334 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2335 @end deffn
2336
2337 @section Interface Drivers
2338
2339 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2340 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2341 available at run time.
2342
2343 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2344 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2345 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2346 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2347
2348 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2349 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2350 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2354 Displays status of RTCK option.
2355 Optionally sets that option first.
2356 @end deffn
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2360 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2361 This has one driver-specific command:
2362
2363 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2364 Logs some status
2365 @end deffn
2366 @end deffn
2367
2368 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2369 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2370 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2371 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2372 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2373 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2374 @end deffn
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2377 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2378
2379 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2380 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2381 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2382 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2383 @example
2384 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2385 @end example
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2389 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2390 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2394 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2395 @end deffn
2396 @end deffn
2397
2398 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2399 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2403 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2404 @end deffn
2405
2406 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft2232}
2407 FTDI FT2232 (USB) based devices over one of the userspace libraries.
2408
2409 Note that this driver has several flaws and the @command{ftdi} driver is
2410 recommended as its replacement.
2411
2412 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2413 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2414
2415 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_device_desc} description
2416 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2417 of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not
2418 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2419 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_serial} serial-number
2423 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the FTDI FT2232 device to use,
2424 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one FT2232 device
2425 is connected to the host.
2426 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2427 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2428 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_layout} name
2432 Each vendor's FT2232 device can use different GPIO signals
2433 to control output-enables, reset signals, and LEDs.
2434 Currently valid layout @var{name} values include:
2435 @itemize @minus
2436 @item @b{axm0432_jtag} Axiom AXM-0432
2437 @item @b{comstick} Hitex STR9 comstick
2438 @item @b{cortino} Hitex Cortino JTAG interface
2439 @item @b{evb_lm3s811} TI/Luminary Micro EVB_LM3S811 as a JTAG interface,
2440 either for the local Cortex-M3 (SRST only)
2441 or in a passthrough mode (neither SRST nor TRST)
2442 This layout can not support the SWO trace mechanism, and should be
2443 used only for older boards (before rev C).
2444 @item @b{luminary_icdi} This layout should be used with most TI/Luminary
2445 eval boards, including Rev C LM3S811 eval boards and the eponymous
2446 ICDI boards, to debug either the local Cortex-M3 or in passthrough mode
2447 to debug some other target. It can support the SWO trace mechanism.
2448 @item @b{flyswatter} Tin Can Tools Flyswatter
2449 @item @b{icebear} ICEbear JTAG adapter from Section 5
2450 @item @b{jtagkey} Amontec JTAGkey and JTAGkey-Tiny (and compatibles)
2451 @item @b{jtagkey2} Amontec JTAGkey2 (and compatibles)
2452 @item @b{m5960} American Microsystems M5960
2453 @item @b{olimex-jtag} Olimex ARM-USB-OCD and ARM-USB-Tiny
2454 @item @b{oocdlink} OOCDLink
2455 @c oocdlink ~= jtagkey_prototype_v1
2456 @item @b{redbee-econotag} Integrated with a Redbee development board.
2457 @item @b{redbee-usb} Integrated with a Redbee USB-stick development board.
2458 @item @b{sheevaplug} Marvell Sheevaplug development kit
2459 @item @b{signalyzer} Xverve Signalyzer
2460 @item @b{stm32stick} Hitex STM32 Performance Stick
2461 @item @b{turtelizer2} egnite Software turtelizer2
2462 @item @b{usbjtag} "USBJTAG-1" layout described in the OpenOCD diploma thesis
2463 @end itemize
2464 @end deffn
2465
2466 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2467 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not specified, the FTDI
2468 default values are used.
2469 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2470 @example
2471 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2472 @end example
2473 @end deffn
2474
2475 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_latency} ms
2476 On some systems using FT2232 based JTAG interfaces the FT_Read function call in
2477 ft2232_read() fails to return the expected number of bytes. This can be caused by
2478 USB communication delays and has proved hard to reproduce and debug. Setting the
2479 FT2232 latency timer to a larger value increases delays for short USB packets but it
2480 also reduces the risk of timeouts before receiving the expected number of bytes.
2481 The OpenOCD default value is 2 and for some systems a value of 10 has proved useful.
2482 @end deffn
2483
2484 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_channel} channel
2485 Used to select the channel of the ft2232 chip to use (between 1 and 4).
2486 The default value is 1.
2487 @end deffn
2488
2489 For example, the interface config file for a
2490 Turtelizer JTAG Adapter looks something like this:
2491
2492 @example
2493 interface ft2232
2494 ft2232_device_desc "Turtelizer JTAG/RS232 Adapter"
2495 ft2232_layout turtelizer2
2496 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xbdc8
2497 @end example
2498 @end deffn
2499
2500 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2501 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2502 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2503 It is a complete rewrite to address a large number of problems with the ft2232
2504 interface driver.
2505
2506 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2507 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX. Performance-wise it is
2508 consistently faster than the ft2232 driver, sometimes several times faster.
2509
2510 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2511 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2512 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2513
2514 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2515 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2516 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2517 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2518 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2519 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2520
2521 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2522 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2523 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2524 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2525
2526 @itemize @minus
2527 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2528 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2529 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2530 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2531 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2532 switching data and direction as necessary
2533 @end itemize
2534
2535 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2536 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2537
2538 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2539 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2540 default values are used.
2541 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2542 @example
2543 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2544 @end example
2545 @end deffn
2546
2547 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2548 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2549 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2550 during device selection.
2551 @end deffn
2552
2553 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2554 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2555 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2556 is connected to the host.
2557 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2558 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2559 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2560 @end deffn
2561
2562 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2563 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2564 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2565 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2566 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2567 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2568
2569 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2570 @end deffn
2571
2572 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2573 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2574 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2575 @end deffn
2576
2577 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2578 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2579 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2580 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2581 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2582 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2583 and initially asserted reset signals.
2584 @end deffn
2585
2586 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2587 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2588 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2589 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2590 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2591 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2592 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2593 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2594 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2595 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2596 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2597
2598 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2599 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2600 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2601 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2602 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2603 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2604
2605 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2606 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2607 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2608 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2609 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2610 are always driven by the FTDI.
2611
2612 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2613 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2614 @var{name}.
2615 @end deffn
2616
2617 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2618 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2619 @itemize @minus
2620 @item @option{0}, drive low
2621 @item @option{1}, drive high
2622 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2623 @end itemize
2624 @end deffn
2625
2626 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2627 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2628 @end deffn
2629
2630 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2631 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2632
2633 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2634 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possiblity to sample
2635 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2636 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2637 @itemize @minus
2638 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2639 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2640 @end itemize
2641 @end deffn
2642
2643 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2644 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2645
2646 @end deffn
2647
2648 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2649 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2650 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2651 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2652
2653 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2654 processors which are being simulated.
2655
2656 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2657 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2658 sockets instead of TCP.
2659 @end deffn
2660
2661 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2662 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2663 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2664 @end deffn
2665
2666 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2667 something like:
2668
2669 @example
2670 interface remote_bitbang
2671 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2672 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2673 @end example
2674
2675 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2676 named mysocket:
2677
2678 @example
2679 interface remote_bitbang
2680 remote_bitbang_port 0
2681 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2682 @end example
2683 @end deffn
2684
2685 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2686 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2687 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2688 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2689
2690 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2691 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2692 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2693 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2694 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2695 @end deffn
2696
2697 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2698 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2699 default values are used.
2700 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2701 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2702 @example
2703 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2704 @end example
2705 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2706 @example
2707 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2708 @end example
2709 @end deffn
2710
2711 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2712 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2713 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2714 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2715 target board.
2716
2717 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2718 @example
2719 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2720 reset_config srst_only
2721 @end example
2722 @end deffn
2723
2724 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ftd2xx}|@option{ublast2})
2725 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2726 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2727 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2728 @end deffn
2729
2730 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2731 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2732 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2733 @end deffn
2734
2735 @end deffn
2736
2737 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2738 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2739 This has one driver-specific command:
2740
2741 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2742 Display either the address of the I/O port
2743 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2744 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2745 This is a write-once setting.
2746 @end deffn
2747 @end deffn
2748
2749 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2750 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2751 transports.
2752
2753 @quotation Compatibility Note
2754 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2755 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2756 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2757 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2758 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2759 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2760 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2761 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2762 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2763 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2764 @end quotation
2765
2766 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2767 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2768 states.
2769 @end deffn
2770 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2771 Display free device internal memory.
2772 @end deffn
2773 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2774 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2775 command version.
2776 @end deffn
2777 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2778 Display the device configuration.
2779 @end deffn
2780 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2781 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2782 power state.
2783 @end deffn
2784 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2785 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2786 @end deffn
2787 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2788 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2789 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2790 IP configuration.
2791 @end deffn
2792 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2793 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2794 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2795 @end deffn
2796 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2797 Reset the current configuration.
2798 @end deffn
2799 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2800 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2801 @end deffn
2802 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2803 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2804 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2805 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2806 instead.
2807
2808 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2809 @end deffn
2810 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2811 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2812 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2813
2814 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2815 @end deffn
2816 @end deffn
2817
2818 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2819 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2820 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2821 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2822 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2823
2824 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2825 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2826 This is a write-once setting.
2827 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2828
2829 @itemize @minus
2830 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2831 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2832 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2833 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2834 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2835 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2836 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2837 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2838 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2839 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2840 some versions of
2841 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2842 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2843 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2844 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2845 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2846 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2847 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2848 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2849 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2850 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2851 @end itemize
2852 @end deffn
2853
2854 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2855 Display either the address of the I/O port
2856 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2857 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2858 This is a write-once setting.
2859
2860 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2861 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2862 you may encounter a problem.
2863 @end deffn
2864
2865 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2866 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2867 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2868 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2869 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2870 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2871
2872 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2873 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2874 @quotation Tip
2875 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2876 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2877 @example
2878 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2879 > adapter_khz 500
2880 @end example
2881 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2882 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2883 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2884 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2885 large set of samples.
2886 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2887 @example
2888 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2889 @end example
2890 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2891 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2892
2893 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2894 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2895 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2896 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2897 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2898 @end quotation
2899 @end deffn
2900
2901 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2902 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2903 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2904 @end deffn
2905
2906 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2907 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2908
2909 @example
2910 interface parport
2911 parport_port 0x278
2912 parport_cable wiggler
2913 @end example
2914 @end deffn
2915
2916 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2917 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2918 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2919 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2920 @end deffn
2921 @end deffn
2922
2923 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2924 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2925 @end deffn
2926
2927 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2928 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2929 @end deffn
2930
2931 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2932 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2933
2934 @quotation Note
2935 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2936 which are not currently documented here.
2937 @end quotation
2938 @end deffn
2939
2940 @anchor{hla_interface}
2941 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2942 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2943 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2944 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2945
2946 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2947 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2948 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2949 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2950 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2951
2952 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2953 Currently Not Supported.
2954 @end deffn
2955
2956 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2957 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2958 @end deffn
2959
2960 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2961 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2962 @end deffn
2963
2964 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2965 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2966 @end deffn
2967
2968 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2969 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2970 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2971 @end deffn
2972 @end deffn
2973
2974 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2975 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2976 @end deffn
2977
2978 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2979 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2980 @end deffn
2981
2982 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2983 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2984 @end deffn
2985
2986 @quotation Note
2987 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2988 which are not currently documented here.
2989 @end quotation
2990
2991 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2992 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2993 No arguments: print status.
2994 @end deffn
2995
2996 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2997 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2998 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2999
3000 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3001 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3002 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3003 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3004 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3005 configuration on exit.
3006
3007 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3008 pinout.
3009
3010 @end deffn
3011
3012 @section Transport Configuration
3013 @cindex Transport
3014 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3015 and the debug adapter you are using,
3016 several transports may be available to
3017 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3018 @deffn Command {transport list}
3019 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3020 version of OpenOCD.
3021 @end deffn
3022
3023 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3024 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3025
3026 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3027 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3028 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3029 adapter's driver).
3030
3031 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3032 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3033 supported by the debug adapter.
3034
3035 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3036 transport, if any.
3037 @end deffn
3038
3039 @subsection JTAG Transport
3040 @cindex JTAG
3041 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3042 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3043 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3044 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3045 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3046 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3047
3048 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3049 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3050 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3051 hla_jtag}.
3052
3053 @subsection SWD Transport
3054 @cindex SWD
3055 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3056 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3057 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3058 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3059 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3060 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3061 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3062
3063 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3064 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3065 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3066 hla_swd}.
3067
3068 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3069 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3070 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3071 expected to change.
3072 @end deffn
3073 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3074 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3075 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3076 No parameters: displays current settings.
3077 @end deffn
3078
3079 @subsection SPI Transport
3080 @cindex SPI
3081 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3082 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3083 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3084 solution for flash programming.
3085
3086 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3087 @section JTAG Speed
3088 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3089 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3090 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3091 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3092 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3093 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3094 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3095 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3096 power management software that may be active.
3097
3098 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3099 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3100 target event handler.
3101 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3102 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3103 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3104 sets up those clocks).
3105 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3106 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3107 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3108 in the target config file.
3109 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3110 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3111 config file instead.
3112 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3113 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3114 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3115
3116 @example
3117 jtag_rclk 3000
3118 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3119 @end example
3120
3121 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3122 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3123 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3124 may not be the fastest solution.
3125
3126 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3127 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3128 which support adaptive clocking.
3129
3130 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3131 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3132 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3133 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3134 than the speed specified.
3135
3136 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3137 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3138 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3139 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3140
3141 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3142 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3143 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3144 JTAG clocking after setup.
3145 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3146 If the interface device can not
3147 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3148 @end deffn
3149
3150 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3151 @cindex adaptive clocking
3152 @cindex RTCK
3153 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3154 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3155 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3156 @example
3157 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3158 jtag_rclk 3000
3159 @end example
3160 @end defun
3161
3162 @node Reset Configuration
3163 @chapter Reset Configuration
3164 @cindex Reset Configuration
3165
3166 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3167 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3168 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3169 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3170 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3171 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3172 Please see the various board files for examples.
3173
3174 @quotation Note
3175 To maintainers and integrators:
3176 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3177 Normally the board configuration file
3178 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3179 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3180
3181 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3182 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3183 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3184 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3185 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3186 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3187 @end quotation
3188
3189 @section Types of Reset
3190
3191 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3192 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3193 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3194
3195 @itemize @bullet
3196 @item
3197 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3198 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3199 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3200 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3201 @item
3202 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3203 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3204 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3205 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3206 @item
3207 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3208 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3209 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3210 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3211 @item
3212 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3213 several other types of reset.
3214 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3215 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3216 There may be individual module resets.
3217 @end itemize
3218
3219 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3220 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3221 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3222 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3223 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3224 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3225 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3226 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3227 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3228
3229 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3230 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3231
3232 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3233 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3234 common issues are:
3235
3236 @itemize @bullet
3237
3238 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3239 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3240 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3241 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3242 when either of those signals is not connected.
3243 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3244 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3245 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3246 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3247
3248 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3249 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3250 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3251 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3252
3253 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3254 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3255 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3256 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3257 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3258 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3259 hardware debouncing.
3260 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3261 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3262
3263 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3264 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3265 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3266 to use push/pull output drivers.
3267 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3268 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3269 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3270 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3271
3272 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3273 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3274 issues (not limited to errata).
3275 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3276 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3277 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3278 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3279 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3280 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3281 @end itemize
3282
3283 There can also be other issues.
3284 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3285 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3286 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3287 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3288 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3289 Agreement (NDA).
3290
3291 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3292 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3293 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3294
3295 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3296 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3297
3298 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3299
3300 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3301 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3302 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3303 allowing it to be deasserted.
3304 @end deffn
3305
3306 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3307 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3308 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3309 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3310 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3311 @end deffn
3312
3313 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3314 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3315 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3316 allowing it to be deasserted.
3317 @end deffn
3318
3319 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3320 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3321 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3322 @end deffn
3323
3324 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3325 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3326 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3327 configuration scripts.
3328
3329 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3330 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3331 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3332 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3333 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3334 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3335 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3336 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3337
3338 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3339 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3340 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3341 -- may be specified at a time.
3342 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3343 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3344 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3345 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3346 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3347
3348 @itemize
3349 @item
3350 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3351 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3352 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3353 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3354 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3355
3356 @quotation Tip
3357 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3358 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3359 @end quotation
3360
3361 @item
3362 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3363 signal implementations.
3364 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3365 indicating everything behaves normally.
3366 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3367 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3368 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3369 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3370 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3371 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3372 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3373
3374 @item
3375 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3376 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3377 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3378 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3379 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3380 while SRST is asserted.
3381 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3382 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3383
3384 @item
3385 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3386 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3387 is required to use this option.
3388 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3389 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3390 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3391 be asserted before any target connection.
3392 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3393 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3394 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3395 @end itemize
3396
3397 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3398 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3399 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3400 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3401 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3402
3403 @itemize
3404 @item
3405 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3406 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3407 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3408 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3409
3410 @item
3411 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3412 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3413 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3414 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3415 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3416 @end itemize
3417 @end deffn
3418
3419 @section Custom Reset Handling
3420 @cindex events
3421
3422 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3423 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3424 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3425 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3426 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3427 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3428
3429 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3430 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3431 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3432 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3433 want to reset everything at once.
3434
3435 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3436 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3437 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3438 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3439 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3440 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3441 needs special attention.
3442
3443 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3444 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3445 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3446 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3447 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3448 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3449 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3450 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3451
3452 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3453 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3454 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3455 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3456 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3457
3458 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3459 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3460 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3461 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3462 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3463 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3464 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3465 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3466 or potentially some other value.
3467
3468 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3469 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3470 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3471 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3472 (or their associated targets)
3473 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3474
3475 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3476 they return.
3477 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3478 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3479 @end deffn
3480
3481 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3482 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3483 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3484 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3485 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3486 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3487 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3488 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3489 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3490 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3491 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3492 @end deffn
3493
3494 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3495 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3496 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3497 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3498 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3499 @end deffn
3500
3501
3502 @node TAP Declaration
3503 @chapter TAP Declaration
3504 @cindex TAP declaration
3505 @cindex TAP configuration
3506
3507 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3508 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3509
3510 @itemize @bullet
3511 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3512 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3513 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3514 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3515 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3516 start running that code.
3517 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3518 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3519 and missing connections.
3520 @end itemize
3521
3522 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3523 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3524 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3525 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3526 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3527
3528 @section Scan Chains
3529 @cindex scan chain
3530
3531 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3532 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3533 They also need to be added to
3534 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3535 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3536 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3537 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3538 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3539 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3540 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3541 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3542
3543 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3544 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3545 command, presented in the next chapter.
3546 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3547 debugging targets.)
3548 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3549
3550 @verbatim
3551 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3552 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3553 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3554 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3555 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3556 @end verbatim
3557
3558 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3559 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3560 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3561 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3562 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3563 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3564 until they are told to do so.
3565
3566 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3567 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3568 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3569 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3570
3571 @example
3572 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3573 @end example
3574
3575 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3576 by a given chip.
3577 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3578 and so forth.
3579 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3580 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3581 both inside a single chip and between them.
3582 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3583
3584 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3585 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3586 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3587 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3588 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3589 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3590 includes commands something like this:
3591
3592 @example
3593 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3594 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3595 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3596 @end example
3597
3598 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3599 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3600 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3601
3602 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3603 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3604 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3605 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3606 @example
3607 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3608 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3609 @}
3610 @end example
3611 @end deffn
3612
3613 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3614 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3615 and their status.
3616 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3617 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3618 but systems with a JTAG router can
3619 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3620 @end deffn
3621
3622 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3623 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3624
3625 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3626 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3627
3628 @section TAP Names
3629 @cindex dotted name
3630
3631 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3632 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3633 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3634 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3635 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3636 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3637 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3638 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3639
3640 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3641 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3642 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3643
3644 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3645
3646 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3647 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3648 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3649 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3650
3651 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3652 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3653 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3654 overridable.
3655
3656 @cindex TAP naming convention
3657 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3658 and should follow this convention:
3659
3660 @itemize @bullet
3661 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3662 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3663 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3664 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3665 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3666 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3667 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3668 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3669 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3670 with a single TAP;
3671 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3672 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3673 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3674 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3675 @end itemize
3676
3677 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3678
3679 @itemize @bullet
3680 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3681 @*The length in bits of the
3682 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3683 @end itemize
3684
3685 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3686
3687 @itemize @bullet
3688 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3689 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3690 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3691 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3692 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3693 (the TAP is linked in).
3694 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3695 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3696 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3697 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3698 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3699 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3700 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3701 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3702 values that were found but not included in the list.
3703
3704 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3705 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3706 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3707 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3708 hardware to find these values.
3709 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3710 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3711 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3712 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3713 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3714 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3715 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3716 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3717 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3718 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3719 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3720 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3721 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3722 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3723 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3724 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3725 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3726 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3727 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3728 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3729 @end itemize
3730 @end deffn
3731
3732 @section Other TAP commands
3733
3734 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3735 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3736 At this writing this TAP attribute
3737 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3738 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3739 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3740 See the next section for information about the available events.
3741
3742 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3743 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3744 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3745 @end deffn
3746
3747 @section TAP Events
3748 @cindex events
3749 @cindex TAP events
3750
3751 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3752 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3753 The other applies to debugger targets,
3754 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3755
3756 The TAP events currently defined are:
3757
3758 @itemize @bullet
3759 @item @b{post-reset}
3760 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3761 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3762 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3763 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3764 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3765
3766 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3767 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3768 of any particular target.
3769 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3770 @item @b{setup}
3771 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3772 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3773 @item @b{tap-disable}
3774 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3775 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3776 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3777 @item @b{tap-enable}
3778 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3779 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3780 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3781 @end itemize
3782
3783 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3784 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3785 contents to be accurate), you might:
3786
3787 @example
3788 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3789 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3790 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3791 @}
3792 @end example
3793
3794
3795 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3796 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3797 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3798 @cindex jrc
3799
3800 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3801 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3802 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3803 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3804 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3805
3806 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3807 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3808 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3809 be visible.
3810 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3811 ignores, such as:
3812
3813 @itemize
3814 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3815 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3816 TAPs receive new instructions.
3817 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3818 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3819 @end itemize
3820
3821 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3822 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3823 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3824 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3825
3826 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3827 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3828
3829 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3830 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3831 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3832 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3833 should define TAP event handlers using
3834 code that looks something like this:
3835
3836 @example
3837 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3838 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3839 @}
3840 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3841 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3842 @}
3843 @end example
3844
3845 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3846
3847 @example
3848 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3849 @end example
3850
3851 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3852 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3853 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3854 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3855
3856 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3857 If necessary, disables the tap
3858 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3859 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3860 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3861 and "0" if it is disabled.
3862 @end deffn
3863
3864 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3865 If necessary, enables the tap
3866 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3867 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3868 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3869 and "0" if it is disabled.
3870 @end deffn
3871
3872 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3873 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3874 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3875 and "0" if it is disabled.
3876
3877 @quotation Note
3878 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3879 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3880 @end quotation
3881 @end deffn
3882
3883 @anchor{autoprobing}
3884 @section Autoprobing
3885 @cindex autoprobe
3886 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3887
3888 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3889 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3890 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3891 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3892
3893 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3894 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3895 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3896 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3897 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3898 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3899 right when they come out of reset).
3900
3901 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3902
3903 @example
3904 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3905 reset_config trst_and_srst
3906 jtag_rclk 8
3907 @end example
3908
3909 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3910 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3911
3912 @enumerate
3913 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3914 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3915 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3916 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3917 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3918 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3919 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3920 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3921 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3922 that is discovered.
3923 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3924 register, it will report it.
3925 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3926 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3927 @end enumerate
3928
3929 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3930 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3931 that's a bit more complex:
3932
3933 @example
3934 clock speed 8 kHz
3935 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3936 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3937 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3938 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3939 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3940 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3941 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3942 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3943 @end example
3944
3945 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3946 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3947 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3948 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3949 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3950 and so forth.
3951
3952 @node CPU Configuration
3953 @chapter CPU Configuration
3954 @cindex GDB target
3955
3956 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3957 You can also access these targets without GDB
3958 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3959 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3960 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3961 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3962
3963 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3964 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3965
3966 @section Target List
3967 @cindex target, current
3968 @cindex target, list
3969
3970 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3971 where each member has a name.
3972 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3973 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3974 (plural!) command.
3975 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3976 look like with more than one:
3977 @verbatim
3978 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3979 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3980 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
3981 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
3982 @end verbatim
3983
3984 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
3985 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
3986 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
3987 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
3988 space seen by that current target.
3989 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
3990 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
3991 are examples; and there are many more.
3992
3993 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
3994
3995 @deffn Command {target current}
3996 Returns the name of the current target.
3997 @end deffn
3998
3999 @deffn Command {target names}
4000 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4001 @example
4002 foreach t [target names] @{
4003 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4004 @}
4005 @end example
4006 @end deffn
4007
4008 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4009 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4010
4011 @deffn Command targets [name]
4012 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4013 command names are singular.}
4014
4015 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4016 targets in a user friendly form.
4017
4018 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4019 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4020 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4021 @end deffn
4022
4023 @section Target CPU Types
4024 @cindex target type
4025 @cindex CPU type
4026
4027 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4028 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4029 when calling @command{target create}.
4030 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4031 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4032 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4033 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4034 what core-specific commands may be available
4035 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4036 and more.
4037
4038 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4039 since there's a command to list them.
4040
4041 @anchor{targettypes}
4042 @deffn Command {target types}
4043 Lists all supported target types.
4044 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4045
4046 @itemize @bullet
4047 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4048 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4049 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4050 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4051 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4052 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4053 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4054 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4055 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4056 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4057 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4058 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4059 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4060 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4061 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4062 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4063 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4064 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4065 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4066 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4067 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4068 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4069 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4070 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4071 @itemize @minus
4072 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4073 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4074 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4075 @end itemize
4076 And two debug interfaces cores:
4077 @itemize @minus
4078 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4079 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4080 @end itemize
4081 @end itemize
4082 @end deffn
4083
4084 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4085 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4086 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4087 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4088 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4089 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4090 reflect design generations;
4091 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4092 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4093
4094 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4095 @section Target Configuration
4096
4097 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4098 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4099 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4100 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4101 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4102
4103 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4104 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4105 optional parts.
4106 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4107 command, created as part of target creation.
4108
4109 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4110 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4111 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4112 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4113 to be much more board-specific.
4114 The key steps you use might look something like this
4115
4116 @example
4117 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4118 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4119 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4120 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4121 @end example
4122
4123 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4124 on-chip SRAM.
4125 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4126 writes to target memory;
4127 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4128 GDB memory checksumming;
4129 and more.
4130
4131 @quotation Warning
4132 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4133 inaccessible when application code
4134 (such as an operating system)
4135 enables or disables the MMU.
4136 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4137 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4138 easy access to other addresses needed.
4139 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4140 @end quotation
4141
4142 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4143 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4144 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4145 controllers.
4146 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4147 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4148 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4149
4150 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4151 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4152 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4153 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4154 purposes including additional configuration.
4155
4156 @itemize @bullet
4157 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4158 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4159 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4160 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4161
4162 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4163 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4164 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4165 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4166 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4167 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4168 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4169
4170 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4171 @end itemize
4172 @end deffn
4173
4174 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4175 The options accepted by this command may also be
4176 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4177 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4178 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4179
4180 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4181 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4182 and changing its endianness.
4183
4184 @itemize @bullet
4185
4186 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4187 used to access this target.
4188
4189 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4190 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4191
4192 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4193 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4194 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4195 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4196 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4197 same event name assigns only one handler.
4198
4199 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4200 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4201 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4202 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4203 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4204 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4205 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4206
4207 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4208 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4209 or virtual address is being used.
4210
4211 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4212 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4213
4214 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4215 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4216 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4217 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4218 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4219
4220 @anchor{rtostype}
4221 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4222 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4223 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}|@option{mqx}
4224 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4225
4226 @end itemize
4227 @end deffn
4228
4229 @section Other $target_name Commands
4230 @cindex object command
4231
4232 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4233 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4234
4235 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4236 Once a button is created a button
4237 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4238 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4239 configure it like this:
4240
4241 @example
4242 # Create
4243 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4244 # Modify
4245 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4246 # Query
4247 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4248 # Report
4249 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4250 @end example
4251
4252 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4253 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4254
4255 @example
4256 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4257 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4258 @end example
4259
4260 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4261
4262 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine}
4263 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4264 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4265 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4266 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4267 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4268 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4269 They are not otherwise documented here.
4270 @end deffn
4271
4272 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4273 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4274 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4275 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4276 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4277 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4278 the target side uses raw memory.
4279
4280 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4281 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4282 The script orientation comes from working with data
4283 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4284 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4285 and neither store nor return those values.
4286
4287 @itemize
4288 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4289 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4290 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4291 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4292 @end itemize
4293 @end deffn
4294
4295 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4296 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4297 @command{$target_name configure}
4298 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4299 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4300 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4301 There are a few special cases:
4302
4303 @itemize @bullet
4304 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4305 event named @var{event_name}.
4306 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4307 two parameters.
4308 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4309 This is a special case because this is set using
4310 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4311 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4312 @end itemize
4313
4314 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4315 all the targets you might use something like this:
4316
4317 @example
4318 foreach name [target names] @{
4319 set y [$name cget -endian]
4320 set z [$name cget -type]
4321 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4322 $x $name $y $z]
4323 @}
4324 @end example
4325 @end deffn
4326
4327 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4328 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4329 Displays the current target state:
4330 @code{debug-running},
4331 @code{halted},
4332 @code{reset},
4333 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4334 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4335 @end deffn
4336
4337 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4338 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4339 currently associated with this target.
4340 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4341 @end deffn
4342
4343 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4344 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4345 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4346 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4347 @end deffn
4348
4349 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4350 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4351 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4352 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4353 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4354 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4355 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4356 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4357 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4358 @end deffn
4359
4360 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4361 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4362 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4363 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4364 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4365 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4366 @end deffn
4367
4368 @anchor{targetevents}
4369 @section Target Events
4370 @cindex target events
4371 @cindex events
4372 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4373 For example:
4374 @itemize @bullet
4375 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4376 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4377 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4378 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4379 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4380 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4381 to set up system clocks or
4382 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4383 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4384 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4385 @end itemize
4386
4387 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4388 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4389 @command{target create ... -event}.
4390
4391 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4392 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4393 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4394
4395 @example
4396 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4397 echo "Reset..."
4398 reset halt
4399 @}
4400 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4401 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4402 echo "Reset..."
4403 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4404 # we need a reset init.
4405 reset init
4406 @}
4407 @end example
4408
4409 The following target events are defined:
4410
4411 @itemize @bullet
4412 @item @b{debug-halted}
4413 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4414 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4415 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4416 @item @b{early-halted}
4417 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4418 @item @b{examine-start}
4419 @* Before target examine is called.
4420 @item @b{examine-end}
4421 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4422 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4423 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4424 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4425 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4426 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4427 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4428 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4429 @* When GDB disconnects
4430 @item @b{gdb-end}
4431 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4432 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4433 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4434 @code{reset init})
4435 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4436 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4437 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4438 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4439 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4440 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4441 @item @b{gdb-start}
4442 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4443 @item @b{halted}
4444 @* The target has halted
4445 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4446 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4447 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4448 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4449 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4450 @item @b{reset-assert}
4451 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4452 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4453 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4454 it instead of asserting SRST.
4455 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4456 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4457 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4458 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4459 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4460 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4461 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4462 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4463 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4464 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4465 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4466 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4467 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4468 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4469 released on the scan chain.
4470 @item @b{reset-end}
4471 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4472 @ignore
4473 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4474 @* Currently not used
4475 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4476 @* Currently not used
4477 @end ignore
4478 @item @b{reset-init}
4479 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4480 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4481
4482 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4483 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4484 multiplexing, and so on.
4485 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4486 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4487 @item @b{reset-start}
4488 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4489 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4490
4491 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4492 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4493 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4494 @ignore
4495 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4496 @* Currently not used
4497 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4498 @* Currently not used
4499 @end ignore
4500 @item @b{resume-start}
4501 @* Before any target is resumed
4502 @item @b{resume-end}
4503 @* After all targets have resumed
4504 @item @b{resumed}
4505 @* Target has resumed
4506 @item @b{trace-config}
4507 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4508 @end itemize
4509
4510 @node Flash Commands
4511 @chapter Flash Commands
4512
4513 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4514 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4515 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4516 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4517 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4518 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4519 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4520 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4521 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4522
4523 Flash Steps:
4524 @enumerate
4525 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4526 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4527 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4528 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4529 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4530 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4531 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4532 @item GDB Flashing
4533 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4534 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4535 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4536 @end enumerate
4537
4538 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4539 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4540 so that it can't boot.
4541 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4542 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4543
4544 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4545 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4546 @cindex flash configuration
4547
4548 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4549 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4550 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4551 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4552 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4553 see the driver-specific documentation.
4554
4555 @itemize @bullet
4556 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4557 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4558 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4559 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4560 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4561 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4562 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4563 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4564 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4565 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4566 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4567 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4568 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4569 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4570 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4571 commands to the flash controller.
4572 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4573 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4574 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4575 for more information.
4576 @end itemize
4577 @quotation Note
4578 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4579 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4580 @end quotation
4581 @end deffn
4582
4583 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4584 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4585 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4586 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4587 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4588 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4589 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4590 @end deffn
4591
4592 @deffn Command {flash list}
4593 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4594 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4595 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4596 @end deffn
4597
4598 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4599 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4600 depends on the flash type.
4601 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4602 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4603 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4604 but most don't bother.
4605 @end deffn
4606
4607 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4608 @cindex flash erasing
4609 @cindex flash reading
4610 @cindex flash writing
4611 @cindex flash programming
4612 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4613
4614 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4615 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4616 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4617 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4618 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4619
4620 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4621 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4622 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4623 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4624 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4625
4626 @quotation Note
4627 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4628 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4629 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4630 back to a flash bank.
4631 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4632 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4633 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4634 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4635 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4636 @end quotation
4637
4638 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4639 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4640 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4641 disabled first.
4642 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4643 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4644 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4645
4646 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4647 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4648 up to and including @var{last}.
4649 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4650 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4651 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4652 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4653 @end deffn
4654
4655 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4656 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4657 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4658 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4659 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4660 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4661 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4662 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4663 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4664 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4665 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4666 before erase starts.
4667 @end deffn
4668
4669 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4670 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4671 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4672 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4673 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4674 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4675 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4676 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4677 before issuing this command.
4678 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4679 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4680 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4681 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4682 @end deffn
4683 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4684
4685 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4686 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4687 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4688 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4689 @end deffn
4690
4691 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename offset length
4692 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4693 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}.
4694 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4695 @end deffn
4696
4697 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename offset
4698 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4699 flash @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. Fails if the contents do not match.
4700 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4701 @end deffn
4702
4703 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4704 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4705 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4706 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4707 to the base address for each section in the image.
4708 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4709 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4710 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4711 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4712 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4713 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4714 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4715 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4716 each image section.
4717
4718 @quotation Warning
4719 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4720 data you want to preserve.
4721 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4722 sections might be erased with no notice.
4723 @itemize
4724 @item
4725 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4726 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4727 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4728 @item
4729 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4730 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4731 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4732 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4733 @end itemize
4734 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4735 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4736 @end quotation
4737
4738 @end deffn
4739
4740 @section Other Flash commands
4741 @cindex flash protection
4742
4743 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4744 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4745 and display that status.
4746 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4747 @end deffn
4748
4749 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
4750 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
4751 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
4752
4753 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4754 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4755 and possibly stale information.
4756 @end deffn
4757
4758 @anchor{flashprotect}
4759 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4760 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4761 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4762 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4763 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4764 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4765 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4766 @end deffn
4767
4768 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4769 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4770 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4771 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4772 @end deffn
4773
4774 @anchor{program}
4775 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4776 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4777 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4778 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4779 @end deffn
4780
4781 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4782 @section Flash Driver List
4783 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4784 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4785 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4786
4787 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4788 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4789 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4790
4791 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4792
4793 @itemize
4794 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4795 @end itemize
4796
4797 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4798 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4799 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4800 @example
4801 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4802 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4803 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4804 @end example
4805 @end deffn
4806
4807 @subsection External Flash
4808
4809 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4810 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4811 @cindex CFI
4812 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4813 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4814 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4815 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4816 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4817 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4818 configure a bus and its timings), or
4819 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4820 on the flash chip.
4821 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4822 speed up operation.
4823
4824 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4825
4826 @itemize
4827 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4828 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4829 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4830 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
4831 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
4832 swapped when writing data values (ie. not CFI commands).
4833 @end itemize
4834
4835 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4836 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4837
4838 @example
4839 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4840 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4841 @end example
4842
4843 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4844 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4845 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4846
4847 @example
4848 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4849 @end example
4850
4851 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4852 @end deffn
4853
4854 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
4855 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
4856 @cindex SPI
4857 @cindex jtagspi
4858 @cindex bscan_spi
4859 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
4860 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
4861 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
4862 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
4863 accessed through JTAG.
4864
4865 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
4866 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
4867 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
4868 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
4869 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires migen
4870 (@url{http://github.com/m-labs/migen}) and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
4871
4872 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
4873 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
4874 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
4875 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
4876 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
4877 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
4878 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
4879 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
4880
4881 @itemize
4882 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
4883 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
4884 @var{USER1} instruction.
4885 @item @var{dr_length} ... is the length of the DR register. This will be 1 for
4886 @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} bitstreams and most other cases.
4887 @end itemize
4888
4889 @example
4890 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
4891 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
4892 set _DR_LENGTH 1
4893 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1 $_DR_LENGTH
4894 @end example
4895 @end deffn
4896
4897 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4898 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4899 @cindex SPIFI
4900 @cindex lpcspifi
4901 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4902 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4903 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4904
4905 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4906 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4907 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4908 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4909 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4910
4911 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4912 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4913 are configured by the driver.
4914
4915 @example
4916 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4917 @end example
4918
4919 @end deffn
4920
4921 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4922 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4923 @cindex SMI
4924 @cindex stmsmi
4925 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4926 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4927 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4928 SPI flash devices.
4929 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4930 flash devices can be connected.
4931
4932 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4933 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4934 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4935 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4936 the flash content.
4937
4938 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4939 to identify the memory bank.
4940 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4941 flash size, are detected automatically.
4942
4943 @example
4944 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4945 @end example
4946
4947 @end deffn
4948
4949 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
4950 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
4951 Microcontroller platform.
4952
4953 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
4954 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
4955
4956 @example
4957 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
4958 @end example
4959
4960 @end deffn
4961
4962 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
4963
4964 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
4965 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
4966 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
4967 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
4968 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
4969 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
4970
4971 @example
4972 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4973 @end example
4974 @end deffn
4975
4976 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
4977 @cindex ambiqmicro
4978 @cindex apollo
4979 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
4980 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
4981 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
4982 with the target using SWD.
4983
4984 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
4985 the device class of the MCU.
4986 The Flash and Sram sizes directly follow device class, and are used
4987 to set up the flash banks.
4988 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
4989 sizes of an Apollo chip.
4990
4991 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
4992 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
4993 and the second bank starts after the first.
4994
4995 @example
4996 # Flash bank 0
4997 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4998 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
4999 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5000 @end example
5001
5002 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5003 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5004 are available to the user.
5005
5006 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5007
5008 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5009 Erase entire bank.
5010 @end deffn
5011 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5012 Erase device pages.
5013 @end deffn
5014 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5015 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5016 The user writes sectors to sram starting at 0x10000010.
5017 Program OTP will write these sectors from sram to flash, and write protect
5018 the flash.
5019 @end deffn
5020 @end deffn
5021
5022 @anchor{at91samd}
5023 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5024 @cindex at91samd
5025 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5026 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5027 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5028
5029 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5030 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5031 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5032 processor to be halted.
5033 @end deffn
5034
5035 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5036 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5037 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5038 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5039 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5040 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5041
5042 @example
5043 at91samd set-security enable
5044 @end example
5045 @end deffn
5046
5047 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5048 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5049 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5050 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5051 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5052 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
5053 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5054 in order to disable this feature.
5055
5056 @example
5057 at91samd eeprom
5058 at91samd eeprom 1024
5059 @end example
5060 @end deffn
5061
5062 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5063 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5064 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5065 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5066 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5067 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5068
5069 @example
5070 at91samd bootloader
5071 at91samd bootloader 16384
5072 @end example
5073 @end deffn
5074
5075 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5076 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5077 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5078 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5079 @end deffn
5080
5081 @end deffn
5082
5083 @anchor{at91sam3}
5084 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5085 @cindex at91sam3
5086 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5087 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5088 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5089 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5090 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5091 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5092 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
5093 chips are confirmed.}
5094
5095 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5096 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5097 the following fixed locations:
5098
5099 @example
5100 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5101 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5102 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5103 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5104 @end example
5105
5106 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5107 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5108 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5109
5110 @itemize
5111 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5112 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5113 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5114 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5115 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5116 @end itemize
5117
5118 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5119
5120 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5121 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5122 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5123 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5124 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5125 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5126 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5127
5128 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5129 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5130 @end deffn
5131
5132 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5133 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5134 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5135 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5136 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5137 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5138 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5139 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5140 @end deffn
5141
5142 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5143 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5144 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5145 @end deffn
5146 @end deffn
5147
5148 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5149 @cindex at91sam4
5150 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5151 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5152 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5153 @end deffn
5154
5155 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5156 @cindex at91sam4l
5157 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5158 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5159 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5160
5161 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5162 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5163 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5164 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5165 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5166 @end deffn
5167 @end deffn
5168
5169 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5170 @cindex atsamv
5171 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5172 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5173 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5174 @end deffn
5175
5176 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5177 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5178 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5179 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5180 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5181
5182 @example
5183 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5184 @end example
5185
5186 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5187 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5188
5189 @itemize
5190 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5191 @item @var{banks}
5192 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5193 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5194 @item @var{pages_size}
5195 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5196 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5197 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5198 @end itemize
5199
5200 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5201 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5202 will be autoconfigured.
5203 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5204
5205 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5206 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5207 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5208 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5209 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5210
5211 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5212 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5213 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5214 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5215 are not truly general purpose).
5216 @quotation Note
5217 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5218 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5219 @end quotation
5220 @end deffn
5221 @end deffn
5222
5223 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5224 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5225 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5226 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5227 @end deffn
5228
5229 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5230 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5231 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5232 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5233 autoconfigures itself.
5234 @example
5235 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5236 @end example
5237 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5238 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5239 this via the following command:
5240 @example
5241 efm32 debuglock num
5242 @end example
5243 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5244 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5245 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5246 supported.}
5247 @end deffn
5248
5249 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5250 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5251 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5252 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5253 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5254 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5255 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5256
5257 @example
5258 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5259 @end example
5260 @end deffn
5261
5262 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5263 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5264 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5265 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5266 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5267 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5268 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5269 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5270 characters) ignored.
5271
5272 @example
5273 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5274 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5275 @end example
5276 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5277 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5278 @end deffn
5279
5280 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5281 @cindex kinetis
5282 Kx and KLx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5283 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5284 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5285 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5286
5287 @example
5288 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5289 @end example
5290
5291 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5292 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5293 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5294 set by 'flash protect' command.
5295 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5296 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5297 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5298 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5299 with the rest of a flash image.
5300 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5301 @end deffn
5302
5303 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5304 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5305 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5306 @end deffn
5307
5308 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5309 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5310 @end deffn
5311
5312 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5313 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5314 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5315 @end deffn
5316
5317 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5318 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5319 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5320 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5321 command completes.
5322 @end deffn
5323
5324 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5325 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5326 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5327 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5328 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5329
5330 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5331 Program Partition command.
5332
5333 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5334 Reset the device after partition setting.
5335
5336 Show partition size:
5337 @example
5338 kinetis nvm_partition info
5339 @end example
5340
5341 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5342 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5343 @example
5344 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5345 @end example
5346
5347 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5348 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5349 @example
5350 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5351 @end example
5352 @end deffn
5353
5354 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5355 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5356 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5357 @end deffn
5358
5359 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5360 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5361 Command disables watchdog timer.
5362 @end deffn
5363 @end deffn
5364
5365 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5366 @cindex kinetis_ke
5367 KE members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5368 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5369 the KE family and sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5370 autoconfigures itself.
5371
5372 @example
5373 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5374 @end example
5375
5376 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5377 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5378 @end deffn
5379
5380 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5381 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5382 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5383 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5384 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5385 @end deffn
5386
5387 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5388 Command disables watchdog timer.
5389 @end deffn
5390 @end deffn
5391
5392 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5393 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5394 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5395 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5396 microcontroller families from NXP.
5397
5398 @quotation Note
5399 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5400 driver:
5401 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5402 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5403 @end quotation
5404
5405 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5406 which must appear in the following order:
5407
5408 @itemize
5409 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5410 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5411 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5412 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5413 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5414 LPC43x[2357])
5415 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5416 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5417 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5418 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5419 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5420 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5421 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5422 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5423 at which the core is running
5424 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5425 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5426 @quotation Note
5427 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5428 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5429 However, if you do provide it,
5430 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5431 @end quotation
5432 @end itemize
5433
5434 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5435
5436 @example
5437 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5438 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5439 @end example
5440
5441 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5442 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5443 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5444 @end deffn
5445 @end deffn
5446
5447 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5448 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5449 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5450 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5451 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5452 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5453
5454 @example
5455 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5456 @end example
5457 @end deffn
5458
5459 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5460 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5461 from NXP.
5462
5463 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5464 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5465 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5466 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5467 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5468 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5469 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5470 you start the PLL.
5471
5472 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5473
5474 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5475 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5476 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5477
5478 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5479 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5480 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5481 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5482 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5483 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5484 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5485
5486 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5487 @example
5488 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5489 @end example
5490
5491 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5492 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5493 @code{flash banks} command.
5494
5495 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5496 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5497 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5498 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5499 a known signature.
5500 Example:
5501 @example
5502 lpc2900 signature 0
5503 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5504 @end example
5505 @end deffn
5506
5507 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5508 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5509 saves it to a file in binary format.
5510 Example:
5511 @example
5512 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5513 @end example
5514 @end deffn
5515
5516 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5517 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5518 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5519 command:
5520
5521 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5522 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5523 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5524 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5525
5526 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5527 Example:
5528 @example
5529 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5530 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5531 @end example
5532 @end deffn
5533
5534 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5535 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5536 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5537 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5538 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5539 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5540 912 bytes.
5541 @quotation Attention
5542 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5543 @end quotation
5544 Example:
5545 @example
5546 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5547 @end example
5548 @end deffn
5549
5550 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5551 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5552 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5553 after the next power cycle.
5554 @quotation Attention
5555 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5556 @end quotation
5557 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5558 Example:
5559 @example
5560 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5561 flash info 0
5562 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5563 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5564 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5565 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5566 @end example
5567 @end deffn
5568
5569 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5570 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5571 effective after the next power cycle.
5572 @quotation Attention
5573 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5574 @end quotation
5575 Examples:
5576 @example
5577 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5578 @end example
5579 @end deffn
5580 @end deffn
5581
5582 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5583 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5584 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5585 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5586
5587 @example
5588 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5589 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5590 @end example
5591
5592 @itemize @bullet
5593 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5594 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5595 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5596 @end itemize
5597
5598 Example usage:
5599 @example
5600 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5601 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5602 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5603 @} else @{
5604 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5605 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5606 @}
5607 @end example
5608 @end deffn
5609
5610 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
5611 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
5612 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5613 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
5614 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
5615 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
5616 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
5617 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
5618 also have division into regions: main and info.
5619 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
5620 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memmory.
5621
5622 @example
5623 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5624 @end example
5625
5626 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
5627
5628 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
5629 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
5630 @end deffn
5631
5632 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
5633 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
5634 @end deffn
5635
5636 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
5637 Erase all userflash including info region.
5638 @end deffn
5639
5640 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
5641 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5642 @end deffn
5643
5644 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
5645 Check sectors protect.
5646 @end deffn
5647
5648 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
5649 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5650 @end deffn
5651
5652 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
5653 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
5654 @end deffn
5655
5656 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
5657 Configure external memory interface for boot.
5658 @end deffn
5659
5660 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
5661 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
5662 @end deffn
5663
5664 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
5665 Show information about flash driver.
5666 @end deffn
5667
5668 @end deffn
5669
5670 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5671 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5672 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5673
5674 @example
5675 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5676 @end example
5677
5678 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5679
5680 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5681 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5682 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5683 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5684 code.
5685 @end deffn
5686
5687 @end deffn
5688
5689 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5690 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5691 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5692
5693 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5694 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5695 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5696 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5697
5698 @example
5699 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5700 @end example
5701 @end deffn
5702
5703 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5704 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5705 and integrate flash memory.
5706
5707 @example
5708 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5709 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5710 @end example
5711
5712 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5713 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5714 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5715 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5716 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5717 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5718 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5719 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5720 @end deffn
5721 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5722 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5723 This will remove any Code Protection.
5724 @end deffn
5725 @end deffn
5726
5727 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5728 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5729 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
5730 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5731 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5732
5733 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5734 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5735
5736 @example
5737 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5738 @end example
5739
5740 psoc4-specific commands
5741 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5742 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5743
5744 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5745 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5746
5747 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5748 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5749 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5750
5751 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5752 @end deffn
5753
5754 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5755 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5756
5757 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5758 @end deffn
5759 @end deffn
5760
5761 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5762 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5763 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5764 and SWD interface.
5765 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5766 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5767
5768 @example
5769 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5770 @end example
5771
5772 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5773
5774 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5775 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5776 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5777 @end deffn
5778
5779 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5780 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5781 @end deffn
5782 @end deffn
5783
5784 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5785 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5786 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5787 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5788 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5789 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5790 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5791 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5792
5793 @example
5794 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5795 @end example
5796
5797 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5798 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5799 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5800 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5801 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5802 disabled.
5803
5804 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5805 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5806 @quotation Warning
5807 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5808 applied to all of them.
5809 @end quotation
5810 @end deffn
5811 @end deffn
5812
5813 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5814 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5815 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5816 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5817 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5818
5819 @example
5820 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5821 @end example
5822
5823 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5824 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5825 the flash driver.
5826
5827 @example
5828 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5829 @end example
5830
5831 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5832 as per the following example.
5833 @example
5834 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5835 @end example
5836
5837 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5838 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5839 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5840 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5841 are defined:
5842
5843 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5844 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5845 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5846 @end deffn
5847
5848 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5849 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5850 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5851 @end deffn
5852
5853 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5854 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5855 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5856 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5857 @end deffn
5858
5859 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5860 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5861 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5862 @end deffn
5863 @end deffn
5864
5865 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5866 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5867 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
5868 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5869 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5870
5871 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5872 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5873 the flash driver.
5874
5875 @example
5876 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5877 @end example
5878
5879 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5880
5881 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5882 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5883 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5884 @end deffn
5885
5886 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5887 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5888 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5889 @end deffn
5890
5891 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
5892 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1.
5893 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5894 @end deffn
5895
5896 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
5897 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
5898 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
5899 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, user_options a
5900 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, boot_addr0 and boot_addr1
5901 two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
5902 @end deffn
5903 @end deffn
5904
5905 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5906 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5907 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5908 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5909 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5910
5911 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5912 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5913 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5914 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5915 second bank.
5916
5917 @example
5918 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5919 @end example
5920
5921 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5922
5923 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5924 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5925 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5926 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5927 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5928 @end deffn
5929 @end deffn
5930
5931 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5932 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5933 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5934 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5935 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5936
5937 @example
5938 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
5939 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5940 @end example
5941
5942 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5943 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5944 for the specified flash bank.
5945 @end deffn
5946 @end deffn
5947
5948 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5949 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5950 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5951 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5952 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5953
5954 @example
5955 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5956 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5957 @end example
5958
5959 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5960 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5961 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5962
5963 @itemize @bullet
5964 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5965 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5966 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5967 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5968 @end itemize
5969 @end deffn
5970
5971 @end deffn
5972
5973 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5974 @cindex str9xpec
5975
5976 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5977 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5978 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5979 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5980
5981 Here is some background info to help
5982 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5983 the str9:
5984 @enumerate
5985 @item
5986 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5987 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5988 @item
5989 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5990 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5991 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5992 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5993 @end enumerate
5994
5995 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5996 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5997 configured for flash bank 0.
5998 @example
5999 # assert srst, we do not want core running
6000 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
6001 jtag_reset 0 1
6002 # turn off target polling
6003 poll off
6004 # disable str9 core
6005 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
6006 # read option bytes
6007 str9xpec options_read 0
6008 # re-enable str9 core
6009 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
6010 poll on
6011 reset halt
6012 @end example
6013 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
6014 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
6015 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
6016 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
6017
6018 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
6019
6020 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
6021 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
6022 @end deffn
6023
6024 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
6025 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
6026 directly to the embedded flash controller.
6027 @end deffn
6028
6029 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
6030 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
6031 erase the device.
6032 @end deffn
6033
6034 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
6035 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
6036 @end deffn
6037
6038 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
6039 Configure str9 boot bank.
6040 @end deffn
6041
6042 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6043 Configure str9 lvd source.
6044 @end deffn
6045
6046 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6047 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6048 @end deffn
6049
6050 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6051 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6052 @end deffn
6053
6054 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6055 Read str9 option bytes.
6056 @end deffn
6057
6058 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6059 Write str9 option bytes.
6060 @end deffn
6061
6062 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6063 unlock str9 device.
6064 @end deffn
6065
6066 @end deffn
6067
6068 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6069 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6070 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6071 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6072
6073 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6074
6075 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6076 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6077 @end deffn
6078
6079 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6080 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6081 @end deffn
6082
6083 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6084 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6085 the flash clock.
6086 @end deffn
6087 @end deffn
6088
6089 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6090 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6091 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6092 @end deffn
6093
6094 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6095 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6096 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6097
6098 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6099
6100 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6101 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6102 @end deffn
6103
6104 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6105 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6106 @end deffn
6107
6108 @end deffn
6109
6110 @section NAND Flash Commands
6111 @cindex NAND
6112
6113 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6114 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6115 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6116
6117 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6118 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6119 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6120 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6121 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6122 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6123
6124 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6125 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6126 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6127 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6128 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6129 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6130 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6131 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6132 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6133 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6134
6135 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6136 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6137 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6138 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6139 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6140 every 512 bytes of data.
6141
6142 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6143 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6144 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6145 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6146 ECC mode is used.
6147
6148 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6149 @enumerate
6150 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6151 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6152 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6153 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6154 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6155 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6156 to access that device.
6157 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6158 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6159 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6160 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6161 de-brick a board.
6162 @end enumerate
6163
6164 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6165 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6166 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6167 are only 32 bits wide.
6168 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6169 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6170 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6171 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6172
6173 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6174 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6175 @cindex NAND configuration
6176
6177 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6178 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6179 OpenOCD has initialized.
6180
6181 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6182 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6183 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6184 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6185 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6186 they were a single (larger) device.
6187 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6188 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6189
6190 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6191 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6192 configuration files, not interactively.
6193
6194 @itemize @bullet
6195 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
6196 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
6197 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
6198 associated with the NAND device being declared.
6199 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
6200 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
6201 commands to the NAND controller.
6202 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
6203 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
6204 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
6205 for more information.
6206 @end itemize
6207 @end deffn
6208
6209 @deffn Command {nand list}
6210 Prints a summary of each device declared
6211 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
6212 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
6213 @example
6214 > nand list
6215 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6216 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6217 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6218 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6219 >
6220 @end example
6221 @end deffn
6222
6223 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
6224 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
6225 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
6226 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6227 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
6228 it with most other NAND commands.
6229 @end deffn
6230
6231 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
6232
6233 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
6234 @cindex NAND reading
6235 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
6236 starting at the specified offset.
6237 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6238
6239 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6240 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6241
6242 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6243 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6244 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6245
6246 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6247 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6248 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6249 method which handled that error correction.
6250
6251 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6252 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6253 @itemize @bullet
6254 @item no oob_* parameter
6255 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6256 @item @code{oob_raw}
6257 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6258 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6259 spare areas associated with each data page.
6260 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6261 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6262 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6263 @item @code{oob_only}
6264 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6265 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6266 spare areas associated with each data page.
6267 @end itemize
6268 @end deffn
6269
6270 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
6271 @cindex NAND erasing
6272 @cindex NAND programming
6273 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
6274 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
6275 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6276 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6277 If those parameters are not specified,
6278 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
6279 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6280
6281 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
6282 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
6283 block marker.
6284 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
6285 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
6286 @end deffn
6287
6288 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
6289 @cindex NAND writing
6290 @cindex NAND programming
6291 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
6292 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
6293 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
6294 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6295
6296 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6297 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6298
6299 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6300 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
6301 past the end of the device.
6302 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
6303 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
6304 if that's being written.)
6305
6306 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
6307 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
6308 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
6309
6310 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
6311 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6312 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6313 @itemize @bullet
6314 @item no oob_* parameter
6315 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6316 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6317 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6318 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6319 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6320 @item @code{oob_only}
6321 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6322 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6323 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6324 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6325 @item @code{oob_raw}
6326 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6327 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6328 un-altered OOB.
6329 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6330 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6331 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6332 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6333 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6334 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6335 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6336 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6337 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6338 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6339 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6340 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6341 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6342 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6343 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6344 @end itemize
6345 @end deffn
6346
6347 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6348 @cindex NAND verification
6349 @cindex NAND programming
6350 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6351 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6352 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6353
6354 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6355 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6356
6357 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6358 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6359 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6360 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6361 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6362
6363 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6364 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6365 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6366
6367 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6368 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6369 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6370 be removed in a future release.
6371 @end deffn
6372
6373 @subsection Other NAND commands
6374 @cindex NAND other commands
6375
6376 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6377 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6378 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6379 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6380 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6381 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6382 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6383 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6384
6385 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6386 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6387 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6388 @end deffn
6389
6390 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6391 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6392 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6393 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6394 status for each block.
6395 @end deffn
6396
6397 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6398 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6399 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6400
6401 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6402 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6403 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6404 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6405 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6406
6407 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6408 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6409 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6410 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6411 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6412 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6413 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6414 @end deffn
6415
6416 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6417 @subsection NAND Driver List
6418 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6419 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6420 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6421
6422 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6423 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6424 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6425 address of the ECC controller.
6426 @example
6427 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6428 @end example
6429 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6430 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6431 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6432 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6433 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6434 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6435 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6436 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6437 @end deffn
6438 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6439 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6440 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6441 @end deffn
6442
6443 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6444 properly configured for input or output.
6445 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6446 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6447 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6448 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6449 @end deffn
6450 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6451 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6452 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6453 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6454 @end deffn
6455 @end deffn
6456
6457 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6458 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6459 chips from Texas Instruments.
6460 It takes three extra parameters:
6461 address of the NAND chip;
6462 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6463 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6464 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6465 @example
6466 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6467 @end example
6468 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6469 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6470 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6471 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6472 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6473 @end deffn
6474
6475 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6476 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6477 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6478 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6479 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6480 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6481 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6482 @end deffn
6483
6484 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6485 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6486 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6487 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6488 @end deffn
6489 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6490
6491 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6492 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6493 should work for this chip aswell.
6494 @end deffn
6495
6496 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6497 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6498 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6499 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6500 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6501 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6502 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6503 @example
6504 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6505 @end example
6506 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6507 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6508 without parameter query status.
6509 @end deffn
6510 @end deffn
6511
6512 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6513 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6514 parameter: the address of the controller.
6515 @example
6516 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6517 @end example
6518 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6519 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6520 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6521 change any behavior.
6522 @end deffn
6523
6524 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6525 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6526 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6527 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6528 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6529 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6530 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6531 specialized commands.
6532 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6533 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6534 change any behavior.
6535 @end deffn
6536
6537 @section mFlash
6538
6539 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6540 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6541
6542 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6543 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6544 address @var{base}.
6545 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6546 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6547
6548 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6549
6550 @example
6551 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6552 @end example
6553
6554 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6555
6556 @example
6557 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6558 @end example
6559 @end deffn
6560
6561 @subsection mFlash commands
6562 @cindex mFlash commands
6563
6564 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
6565 Configure mflash PLL.
6566 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
6567 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
6568 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
6569 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
6570 @end deffn
6571
6572 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
6573 Configure bootable option.
6574 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
6575 (4kB) for boot.
6576 @end deffn
6577
6578 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
6579 Configure storage information.
6580 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
6581 written.
6582 @end deffn
6583
6584 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
6585 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
6586 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
6587 @end deffn
6588
6589 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
6590 Probe mflash.
6591 @end deffn
6592
6593 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
6594 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
6595 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
6596 @end deffn
6597
6598 @node Flash Programming
6599 @chapter Flash Programming
6600
6601 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
6602 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
6603 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
6604
6605 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
6606 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
6607
6608 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
6609 @enumerate
6610 @item 'init' is executed.
6611 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
6612 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
6613 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
6614 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
6615 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
6616 @end enumerate
6617
6618 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
6619
6620 @example
6621 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
6622 # are optional parameters
6623 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6624 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
6625
6626 # binary files need the flash address passing
6627 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6628 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
6629 @end example
6630
6631 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6632 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6633 @cindex PLD
6634 @cindex FPGA
6635
6636 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6637 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6638 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6639 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6640 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6641 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6642 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6643
6644 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6645
6646 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6647 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6648 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6649
6650 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6651 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6652
6653 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6654 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6655 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6656 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6657 behavior.
6658 @end deffn
6659
6660 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6661 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6662 @end deffn
6663
6664 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6665 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6666 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6667 @end deffn
6668
6669 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6670
6671 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6672 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6673 that particular type of PLD.
6674
6675 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
6676 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6677 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6678
6679 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
6680 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
6681 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
6682
6683 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6684 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6685 for FPGA @var{num}.
6686 @end deffn
6687 @end deffn
6688
6689 @node General Commands
6690 @chapter General Commands
6691 @cindex commands
6692
6693 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6694 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6695 commands are documented elsewhere.
6696
6697 Intent:
6698 @itemize @bullet
6699 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6700 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6701 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6702 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6703
6704 @item @b{From the human}
6705 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6706 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6707
6708 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6709 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6710 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6711
6712 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6713 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6714 port is 5555.
6715 @end itemize
6716
6717
6718 @section Server Commands
6719
6720 @deffn {Command} exit
6721 Exits the current telnet session.
6722 @end deffn
6723
6724 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6725 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6726 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6727 Not every command provides helptext.
6728
6729 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6730 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6731 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6732 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6733 @end deffn
6734
6735 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6736 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6737 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6738 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6739 Useful in connection with script files
6740 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6741 @end deffn
6742
6743 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6744 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6745 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6746 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6747 @end deffn
6748
6749 @anchor{debuglevel}
6750 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6751 @cindex message level
6752 Display debug level.
6753 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6754 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6755 Level 0 is error messages only;
6756 level 1 adds warnings;
6757 level 2 adds informational messages;
6758 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6759 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6760 the command line along with the location of that log
6761 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6762 @xref{Running}.
6763 @end deffn
6764
6765 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6766 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6767 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6768 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6769 @example
6770 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6771 @end example
6772 @end deffn
6773
6774 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6775 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6776 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6777 @end deffn
6778
6779 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6780 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6781 @end deffn
6782
6783 @deffn Command bindto [name]
6784 Specify address by name on which to listen for incoming TCP/IP connections.
6785 By default, OpenOCD will listen on all available interfaces.
6786 @end deffn
6787
6788 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6789 @section Target State handling
6790 @cindex reset
6791 @cindex halt
6792 @cindex target initialization
6793
6794 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6795 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6796 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6797 a current target which is used to perform the
6798 various operations. The current target may be changed
6799 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6800 target which should become current.
6801
6802 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6803 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6804 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6805 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6806 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6807
6808 @emph{With no arguments}:
6809 list all available registers for the current target,
6810 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6811 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6812 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6813 are flagged as such.
6814
6815 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6816 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6817 bypassing any internal cache.
6818
6819 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6820 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6821 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6822 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6823 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6824 relevant module will flush such values.
6825
6826 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6827 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6828
6829 @example
6830 > reg
6831 ===== ARM registers
6832 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6833 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6834 (2) r2 (/32)
6835 ...
6836 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6837 >
6838 @end example
6839 @end deffn
6840
6841 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6842 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6843 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6844 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6845 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6846 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6847 (and enter debug mode).
6848 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6849
6850 @quotation Warning
6851 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6852 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6853 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6854 power mode by gating the core clock;
6855 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6856
6857 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6858 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6859 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6860 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6861 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6862 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6863
6864 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6865 work with a JTAG debugger.
6866 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6867 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6868 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6869 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6870 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6871 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6872 @end quotation
6873
6874 @end deffn
6875
6876 @deffn Command resume [address]
6877 Resume the target at its current code position,
6878 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6879 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6880 @end deffn
6881
6882 @deffn Command step [address]
6883 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6884 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6885 @end deffn
6886
6887 @anchor{resetcommand}
6888 @deffn Command reset
6889 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6890 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6891 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6892 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6893 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6894 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6895
6896 The optional parameter specifies what should
6897 happen after the reset.
6898 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6899 The other options will not work on all systems.
6900 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6901
6902 @itemize @minus
6903 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6904 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6905 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6906 @end itemize
6907 @end deffn
6908
6909 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6910 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6911 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6912 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6913 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6914 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6915 state.
6916 @end deffn
6917
6918 @section I/O Utilities
6919
6920 These commands are available when
6921 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6922 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6923 notably the ZY1000.
6924 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6925
6926 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6927
6928 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6929 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6930 the text file @file{filename}.
6931 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6932 The last string is followed by a newline.
6933 @end deffn
6934
6935 @deffn Command cat filename
6936 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6937 @end deffn
6938
6939 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6940 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6941 into @file{dest_filename}.
6942 @end deffn
6943
6944 @deffn Command ip
6945 @emph{No description provided.}
6946 @end deffn
6947
6948 @deffn Command ls
6949 @emph{No description provided.}
6950 @end deffn
6951
6952 @deffn Command mac
6953 @emph{No description provided.}
6954 @end deffn
6955
6956 @deffn Command meminfo
6957 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6958 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6959 @end deffn
6960
6961 @deffn Command peek
6962 @emph{No description provided.}
6963 @end deffn
6964
6965 @deffn Command poke
6966 @emph{No description provided.}
6967 @end deffn
6968
6969 @deffn Command rm filename
6970 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6971 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6972 @end deffn
6973
6974 @deffn Command trunc filename
6975 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6976 @end deffn
6977
6978 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6979 @section Memory access commands
6980 @cindex memory access
6981
6982 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6983 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6984 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6985 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6986
6987 @enumerate
6988 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6989 to change the current target.
6990 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6991 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6992 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6993 @end enumerate
6994
6995 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6996 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6997 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6998 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6999 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
7000 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
7001 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7002 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7003 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7004 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7005 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
7006 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
7007 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
7008 @end deffn
7009
7010 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
7011 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
7012 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
7013 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
7014 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
7015 at the specified address @var{addr}.
7016 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7017 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7018 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7019 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7020 @end deffn
7021
7022 @anchor{imageaccess}
7023 @section Image loading commands
7024 @cindex image loading
7025 @cindex image dumping
7026
7027 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
7028 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
7029 binary file named @var{filename}.
7030 @end deffn
7031
7032 @deffn Command {fast_load}
7033 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
7034 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
7035 @end deffn
7036
7037 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
7038 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
7039 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
7040 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
7041 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
7042 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
7043 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
7044 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
7045 separately.
7046 @end deffn
7047
7048 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
7049 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
7050 The file format may optionally be specified
7051 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
7052 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
7053 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
7054 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
7055 @example
7056 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
7057 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7058 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7059 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7060 $address $length
7061 @}
7062 @end example
7063 @end deffn
7064
7065 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7066 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7067 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
7068 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
7069 The file format may optionally be specified
7070 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7071 @end deffn
7072
7073 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7074 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7075 The file format may optionally be specified
7076 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7077 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7078 @end deffn
7079
7080
7081 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7082 @cindex breakpoint
7083 @cindex watchpoint
7084
7085 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7086 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7087 watchpoints.
7088 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7089
7090 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7091 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7092 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7093 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7094 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7095 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7096
7097 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7098 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7099 @end deffn
7100
7101 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7102 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7103 @end deffn
7104
7105 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7106 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7107 @end deffn
7108
7109 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7110 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7111 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7112 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7113 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7114 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7115 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7116 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7117 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7118 @end deffn
7119
7120 @section Misc Commands
7121
7122 @cindex profiling
7123 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7124 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7125 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7126 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7127 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7128 limit the address range.
7129 @end deffn
7130
7131 @deffn Command {version}
7132 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7133 @end deffn
7134
7135 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7136 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7137 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7138 @end deffn
7139
7140 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7141 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7142 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7143 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7144
7145 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7146 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7147 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7148 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7149
7150 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7151 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7152 @cindex tracing
7153 @cindex ETM
7154 @cindex ETB
7155
7156 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7157 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7158 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
7159
7160 @itemize
7161 @item
7162 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
7163 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
7164 supports such an interface.
7165 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
7166 and trace port support.)
7167 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
7168 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
7169 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
7170 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
7171 in the board-specific configuration file.
7172 @item
7173 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
7174 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
7175 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
7176 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
7177 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
7178 @end itemize
7179
7180 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
7181
7182 @quotation Issues
7183 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
7184 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
7185
7186 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
7187 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
7188 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
7189 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
7190 dummy trace port driver}.
7191
7192 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
7193 as well as tracing only during specific states
7194 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
7195
7196 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
7197 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
7198 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
7199 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
7200 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
7201
7202 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
7203 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
7204 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
7205 this original style of JTAG access.
7206 @end quotation
7207
7208 @subsection ETM Configuration
7209 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
7210
7211 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
7212 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
7213 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
7214
7215 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
7216 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
7217 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
7218 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
7219 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
7220 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
7221 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
7222 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
7223 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
7224
7225 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
7226 or @option{demultiplexed}.
7227 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
7228
7229 @quotation Warning
7230 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
7231 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
7232 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
7233 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
7234 @end quotation
7235
7236 @quotation Note
7237 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
7238 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
7239 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
7240 what CPU activities are traced.
7241 @end quotation
7242 @end deffn
7243
7244 @deffn Command {etm info}
7245 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
7246 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
7247 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
7248 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
7249 @end deffn
7250
7251 @deffn Command {etm status}
7252 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
7253 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
7254 Did trace data overflow?
7255 Was it triggered?
7256 @end deffn
7257
7258 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
7259 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
7260 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
7261 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
7262 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
7263
7264 @itemize
7265 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
7266 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
7267 The value is one of
7268 @option{none} (save nothing),
7269 @option{data} (save data),
7270 @option{address} (save addresses),
7271 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
7272 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
7273 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
7274 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
7275 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
7276 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
7277 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
7278 trace stream without an image of the code.
7279 @end itemize
7280 @end deffn
7281
7282 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7283 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
7284 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
7285 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
7286 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
7287
7288 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
7289 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
7290 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
7291 @end deffn
7292
7293 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
7294
7295 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
7296 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
7297 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
7298
7299 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
7300 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
7301 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
7302 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
7303 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
7304 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
7305 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
7306
7307 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
7308
7309 @itemize
7310 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
7311 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
7312 for instruction access within that function's body.
7313 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
7314 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
7315 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
7316 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
7317 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
7318 combining one of the above models with a counter.
7319 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
7320 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
7321 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
7322 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
7323 @item @emph{... more}
7324 @end itemize
7325
7326 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
7327 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
7328
7329 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
7330 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
7331 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
7332 @end deffn
7333
7334 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
7335 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
7336 @end deffn
7337
7338 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
7339 Opens an image file.
7340 @end deffn
7341
7342 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7343 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7344 @end deffn
7345
7346 @deffn Command {etm start}
7347 Starts trace data collection.
7348 @end deffn
7349
7350 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7351 Stops trace data collection.
7352 @end deffn
7353
7354 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7355 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7356
7357 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7358
7359 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7360 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7361 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7362 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7363 any trace data collection.}
7364 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7365 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7366 @end deffn
7367 @end deffn
7368
7369 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7370 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7371 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7372 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7373 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7374 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7375 @end deffn
7376 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7377 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7378 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7379 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7380 trace trigger becomes active.
7381
7382 @itemize
7383 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7384 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7385 afterwards.
7386 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7387 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7388 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7389 what caused that event to happen.
7390 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7391 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7392 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7393 how the event caused trouble.
7394 @end itemize
7395 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7396 @end deffn
7397
7398 @end deffn
7399
7400 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7401 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7402 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7403 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7404 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7405
7406 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7407 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7408
7409 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7410 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7411 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7412 @end deffn
7413
7414 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7415 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7416 @end deffn
7417
7418 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7419 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7420 @end deffn
7421 @end deffn
7422
7423
7424 @section Generic ARM
7425 @cindex ARM
7426
7427 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7428 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7429 commands that may be available.
7430
7431 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7432 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7433 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7434 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7435 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7436 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7437 @end deffn
7438
7439 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7440 @cindex disassemble
7441 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7442 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7443 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7444 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7445 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7446 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7447 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7448
7449 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7450 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7451 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7452 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7453 with a handful of exceptions.
7454 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7455 @end deffn
7456
7457 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7458 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7459 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7460 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7461 and using the MCR instruction.
7462 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7463 an ARM register.)
7464 @end deffn
7465
7466 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7467 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7468 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7469 and the MRC instruction.
7470 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7471 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7472 an ARM register.)
7473 @end deffn
7474
7475 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7476 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7477 core mode if necessary.
7478 @end deffn
7479
7480 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7481 @cindex ARM semihosting
7482 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7483
7484 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7485 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7486 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7487 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7488 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7489 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7490 @end deffn
7491
7492 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7493 @cindex ARMv4
7494 @cindex ARMv5
7495
7496 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7497 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7498 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7499 variant.
7500
7501 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7502 @cindex ARM7
7503 @cindex ARM9
7504
7505 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7506 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7507 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7508 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7509
7510 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7511 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7512 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7513 instead of breakpoints.
7514 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7515
7516 This should be
7517 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7518 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7519 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7520 @end deffn
7521
7522 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7523 @cindex DCC
7524 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7525 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7526 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7527
7528 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7529 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7530 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7531 @end deffn
7532
7533 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7534 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7535 that don't check completion of the operation.
7536 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7537
7538 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7539 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7540 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7541 @end deffn
7542
7543 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7544 @cindex ARM720T
7545
7546 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7547 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7548 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7549 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7550
7551 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7552 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7553 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7554
7555 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7556 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7557 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7558 @end deffn
7559
7560 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7561 @cindex ARM9
7562
7563 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7564 integer processors.
7565 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7566
7567 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7568 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7569 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7570 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7571
7572 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7573 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7574 @cindex vector_catch
7575 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7576 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7577 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7578 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7579 to those hardware vectors.
7580
7581 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7582 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7583 vector catch hardware to intercept
7584 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7585 @option{none} of them,
7586 or a list with one or more of the following:
7587 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7588 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7589 @end deffn
7590
7591 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7592 @cindex ARM920T
7593
7594 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7595 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7596 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7597 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7598 and ARM9 commands.
7599
7600 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7601 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7602 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7603 @end deffn
7604
7605 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7606 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7607 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7608 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7609 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7610 (Not all registers can be written.)
7611 @end deffn
7612
7613 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7614 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7615 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7616
7617 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7618 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7619 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7620 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7621 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7622 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7623 @end deffn
7624
7625 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7626 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7627 @end deffn
7628
7629 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7630 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7631 @end deffn
7632
7633 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7634 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7635
7636 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7637 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7638 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7639 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7640 and ARM9 commands.
7641
7642 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7643 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7644
7645 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7646 Print information about the caches found.
7647 @end deffn
7648
7649 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7650 @cindex ARM966E
7651
7652 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7653 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7654 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7655 and ARM9 commands.
7656
7657 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7658 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7659 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7660 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7661 ARM966E-S TRM.
7662 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7663 as required for BIST support.
7664 @end deffn
7665
7666 @subsection XScale specific commands
7667 @cindex XScale
7668
7669 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7670
7671 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7672 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7673 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7674 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7675 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7676 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7677 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7678
7679 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7680 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7681 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7682 the mini-IC.
7683
7684 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7685 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7686 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7687 code layout in memory:
7688 @example
7689 _vectors:
7690 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7691 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7692 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7693 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7694 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7695 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7696 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7697 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7698 .org 0x100
7699 .long real_reset_vector
7700 .long real_ui_handler
7701 .long real_swi_handler
7702 .long real_pf_abort
7703 .long real_data_abort
7704 .long 0 /* unused */
7705 .long real_irq_handler
7706 .long real_fiq_handler
7707 @end example
7708
7709 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7710 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7711 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7712 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7713 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7714 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7715 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7716 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7717 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7718 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7719 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7720 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7721 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7722 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7723 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7724 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7725 software.
7726
7727 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7728 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7729 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7730 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7731
7732 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7733 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7734 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7735 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7736 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7737 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7738 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7739 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7740 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7741
7742 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7743 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7744
7745 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7746 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7747 @end deffn
7748
7749 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7750 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7751 @end deffn
7752
7753 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7754 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7755 @end deffn
7756
7757 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7758 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7759 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7760 @end deffn
7761
7762 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7763 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7764 @end deffn
7765
7766 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7767 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7768 @end deffn
7769
7770 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7771 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7772 @end deffn
7773
7774 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7775 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7776 @end deffn
7777
7778 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7779 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7780 @end deffn
7781
7782 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7783 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7784 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7785 and modifying how it is emptied.
7786 @end deffn
7787
7788 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7789 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7790 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7791 The image @var{type} may be one of
7792 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7793 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7794 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7795 @end deffn
7796
7797 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7798 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7799 @cindex vector_catch
7800 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7801 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7802
7803 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7804 @example
7805 0x01 Trap Reset
7806 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7807 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7808 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7809 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7810 0x20 reserved
7811 0x40 Trap IRQ
7812 0x80 Trap FIQ
7813 @end example
7814 @end deffn
7815
7816 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7817 @cindex vector_table
7818
7819 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7820 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7821 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7822 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7823 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7824
7825 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7826
7827 @end deffn
7828
7829 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7830 @cindex ARMv6
7831
7832 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7833 @cindex ARM11
7834
7835 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7836 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7837 which is enabled by default.
7838 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7839 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7840 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7841 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7842 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7843 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7844 @end deffn
7845
7846 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7847 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7848 which is enabled by default.
7849 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7850 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7851 @end deffn
7852
7853 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7854 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7855 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7856 they are disabled by default.
7857 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7858 @end deffn
7859
7860 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7861 @cindex vector_catch
7862 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7863 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7864 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7865
7866 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7867 for certain hardware events.
7868 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7869 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7870 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7871 @end deffn
7872
7873 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7874 @cindex ARMv7
7875
7876 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7877 @cindex Debug Access Port
7878 @cindex DAP
7879 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7880 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7881 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7882
7883 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7884 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7885 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7886 @end deffn
7887
7888 @deffn Command {dap apreg} ap_num reg [value]
7889 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
7890 or set a new value @var{value}.
7891 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
7892 @end deffn
7893
7894 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7895 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7896 @end deffn
7897
7898 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7899 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7900 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7901 @end deffn
7902
7903 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7904 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7905 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7906 @end deffn
7907
7908 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7909 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7910 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7911 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7912 @end deffn
7913
7914 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7915 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7916 Defaulting to 0.
7917 @end deffn
7918
7919 @deffn Command {dap ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
7920 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
7921 Disabled by default
7922 @end deffn
7923
7924
7925 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
7926 @cindex Cortex-A
7927
7928 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
7929 display information about target caches
7930 @end deffn
7931
7932 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
7933 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
7934 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
7935 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
7936 Defaults to 'off'.
7937 @end deffn
7938
7939 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
7940 Initialize core debug
7941 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7942 @end deffn
7943
7944 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
7945 Disable SMP mode
7946 @end deffn
7947
7948 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
7949 Enable SMP mode
7950 @end deffn
7951
7952 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
7953 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
7954 @end deffn
7955
7956 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7957 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7958 @end deffn
7959
7960 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
7961 configure l2x cache
7962 @end deffn
7963
7964
7965 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
7966 @cindex Cortex-R
7967
7968 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
7969 Initialize core debug
7970 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7971 @end deffn
7972
7973 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7974 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7975 @end deffn
7976
7977
7978 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
7979 @cindex tracing
7980 @cindex SWO
7981 @cindex SWV
7982 @cindex TPIU
7983 @cindex ITM
7984 @cindex ETM
7985
7986 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
7987 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
7988 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
7989
7990 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
7991 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
7992 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
7993 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
7994
7995 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
7996 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
7997 debugger adapter features.
7998
7999 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
8000 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
8001
8002 Command options:
8003 @itemize @minus
8004 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
8005 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
8006 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
8007 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8008 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
8009 either a regular file or a named pipe);
8010 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8011 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
8012 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
8013 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
8014 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
8015 coding;
8016 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
8017 regular UART 8N1) coding;
8018 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
8019 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
8020 data is to be output via SWO;
8021 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
8022 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
8023 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
8024 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
8025 rate automatically.
8026 @end itemize
8027
8028 Example usage:
8029 @enumerate
8030 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
8031 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
8032 enough to:
8033 @example
8034 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
8035 ...
8036 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
8037 ...
8038 @end example
8039 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
8040 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
8041 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
8042 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
8043 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
8044 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
8045 @example
8046 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
8047 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
8048 @end example
8049 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
8050 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
8051 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
8052 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
8053 @example
8054 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
8055 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
8056 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
8057 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
8058 @end example
8059 @end enumerate
8060 @end deffn
8061
8062 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8063 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8064 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8065 @end deffn
8066
8067 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8068 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8069 @end deffn
8070
8071 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8072 @cindex Cortex-M
8073
8074 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8075 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8076
8077 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
8078 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8079 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8080 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8081 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8082 the step command leaves with the core running.
8083
8084 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
8085 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
8086 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
8087
8088 Default is @option{auto}.
8089 @end deffn
8090
8091 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8092 @cindex vector_catch
8093 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8094 for certain hardware events.
8095
8096 Parameters request interception of
8097 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8098 @option{none} of them,
8099 or one or more of the following:
8100 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
8101 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
8102 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
8103 @option{irq_err},
8104 @option{state_err},
8105 @option{chk_err}, or
8106 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
8107 @option{reset}.
8108 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
8109 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
8110 are mapped to HardFault.
8111 UsageFault checks for
8112 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
8113 must also be explicitly enabled.
8114
8115 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
8116 @end deffn
8117
8118 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
8119 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
8120 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8121 @itemize @minus
8122 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8123 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
8124 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
8125 @end itemize
8126 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
8127 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
8128 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
8129 the peripherals.
8130 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
8131 @end deffn
8132
8133 @section Intel Architecture
8134
8135 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
8136 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
8137 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
8138 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
8139 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
8140 @itemize
8141 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
8142 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
8143 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
8144 @end itemize
8145
8146 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
8147 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
8148 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
8149
8150 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
8151 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8152 @end deffn
8153
8154 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
8155 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8156 @end deffn
8157
8158 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
8159 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8160 @end deffn
8161
8162 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
8163 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8164 @end deffn
8165
8166 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
8167 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8168 @end deffn
8169
8170 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
8171 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8172 @end deffn
8173
8174 @section OpenRISC Architecture
8175
8176 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
8177 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
8178
8179 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
8180 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
8181 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
8182 @end deffn
8183 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
8184 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
8185
8186 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
8187
8188 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
8189 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
8190 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
8191 @end deffn
8192
8193 @subsection Registers commands
8194 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
8195 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
8196 included in the generated target descriptor file.
8197
8198 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
8199
8200 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
8201 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
8202 and "timer" groups.
8203
8204 @emph{example:}
8205 @example
8206 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
8207 @end example
8208
8209
8210 @end deffn
8211 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
8212 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
8213
8214 @emph{group} can be "system",
8215 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
8216 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
8217 @end deffn
8218
8219 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
8220 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
8221 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
8222 @cindex tracing
8223 @cindex libdcc
8224 @cindex DCC
8225 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
8226 the target uses appropriate libraries.
8227 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
8228 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
8229
8230 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
8231 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
8232 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
8233 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
8234 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
8235 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
8236
8237 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
8238 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
8239 arrays of various size integers from the target,
8240 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
8241 The target being debugged may
8242 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
8243 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
8244 each supported by a command:
8245
8246 @itemize
8247 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
8248 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
8249 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
8250 finding out how some fault was triggered.
8251
8252 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
8253 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
8254 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
8255
8256 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
8257 and then displayed at any time.
8258 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
8259
8260 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
8261 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
8262 @end itemize
8263
8264 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
8265 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
8266 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
8267 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
8268 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
8269 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
8270 does the same thing.
8271
8272 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
8273 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
8274 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
8275 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
8276 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
8277
8278 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
8279 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
8280 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
8281 @end deffn
8282
8283 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
8284 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
8285 in the order they triggered.
8286 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
8287 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
8288 history records.
8289 @end deffn
8290
8291 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
8292 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
8293 they have been triggered.
8294 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
8295 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
8296 and associates it with that identifier.
8297
8298 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
8299 are not related except by this command.
8300 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
8301 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
8302 @end deffn
8303
8304
8305 @node JTAG Commands
8306 @chapter JTAG Commands
8307 @cindex JTAG Commands
8308 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
8309 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
8310 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
8311 may be needed to work with targets which require special
8312 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
8313
8314 To use these commands you will need to understand some
8315 of the basics of JTAG, including:
8316
8317 @itemize @bullet
8318 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
8319 devices such as a CPUs.
8320 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
8321 standard state machine (in parallel)
8322 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
8323 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
8324 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
8325 while the reading previous ones.
8326 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
8327 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
8328 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
8329 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
8330 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
8331 registers.
8332 @end itemize
8333
8334 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
8335
8336 These commands are used by developers who need to access
8337 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
8338 the order of TAP state transitions.
8339 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
8340 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
8341 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
8342 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
8343 these commands are not available.
8344
8345 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8346 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
8347 that specify the entire register.
8348 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
8349 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
8350 The return value holds the original value of each
8351 of those fields.
8352
8353 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
8354 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
8355 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
8356 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
8357 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
8358
8359 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
8360 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
8361
8362 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8363 in that state.
8364 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
8365 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8366 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8367
8368 @quotation Warning
8369 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
8370 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
8371 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
8372 data registers, which may have different lengths.
8373 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
8374 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
8375 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
8376 (by connecting a different scan chain).
8377 @end quotation
8378 @end deffn
8379
8380 @deffn Command {flush_count}
8381 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
8382 This may be used for performance tuning.
8383
8384 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
8385 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
8386 not change with the amount of data which is written.
8387 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
8388 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
8389 instead of batching them into larger operations.
8390 @end deffn
8391
8392 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8393 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
8394 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
8395 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
8396 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
8397 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
8398
8399 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8400 in that state.
8401 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
8402 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8403 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8404
8405 @quotation Note
8406 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
8407 register values, unlike data register values.
8408 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
8409 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
8410 @end quotation
8411 @end deffn
8412
8413 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
8414 Set values of reset signals.
8415 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
8416 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
8417 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
8418 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8419 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
8420 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8421 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8422
8423 Note that TRST is specially handled.
8424 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8425 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8426 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8427 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8428 instead of the TRST signal.
8429 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8430 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8431 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8432 with handlers for that event.
8433 @end deffn
8434
8435 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
8436 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
8437 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
8438 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
8439 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8440 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8441 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8442 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8443 The final state must also be stable.
8444 @end deffn
8445
8446 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8447 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8448 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8449 Instructions often need some time
8450 to execute before they take effect.
8451 @end deffn
8452
8453 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8454 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8455
8456 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8457 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8458 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8459 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8460 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8461 @end deffn
8462
8463 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8464 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8465 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8466 must also be enabled.
8467 Default is enabled.
8468 @end deffn
8469
8470 @section TAP state names
8471 @cindex TAP state names
8472
8473 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
8474 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
8475 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
8476 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
8477
8478 @itemize @bullet
8479 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8480 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8481 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8482 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8483 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8484 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8485 through the data register
8486 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8487 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8488 for update or more shifting
8489 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8490 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8491 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8492 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8493 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8494 through the instruction register
8495 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8496 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8497 for update or more shifting
8498 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8499 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8500 @end itemize
8501
8502 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8503 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8504 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8505 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8506
8507 @itemize @bullet
8508 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8509 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8510 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8511 may not be as expected.
8512 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8513 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8514 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8515 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8516 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8517 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8518 @end itemize
8519
8520 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8521 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8522
8523 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8524 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8525 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8526 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8527
8528 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8529 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8530 @cindex SVF
8531
8532 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8533 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8534 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8535 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8536
8537 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8538 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8539 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8540 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8541 each command is logged before it is executed.
8542 @end deffn
8543
8544 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8545 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8546 @cindex XSVF
8547
8548 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8549 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8550 Xilinx devices.
8551 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8552 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8553
8554 @quotation Important
8555 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8556 @end quotation
8557
8558 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8559 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8560 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8561 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8562 that TAP.
8563 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8564 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8565 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8566 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8567 @end deffn
8568
8569 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8570 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8571 after building the software.
8572 You may find them useful:
8573
8574 @itemize
8575 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8576 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8577 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8578 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8579 @end itemize
8580
8581 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8582 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8583 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8584 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8585 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8586 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8587 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8588
8589
8590 @node Utility Commands
8591 @chapter Utility Commands
8592 @cindex Utility Commands
8593
8594 @section RAM testing
8595 @cindex RAM testing
8596
8597 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8598 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8599 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8600 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8601 hardware problems.
8602
8603 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8604 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8605 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8606 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8607
8608 Load the memory testing functions with
8609
8610 @example
8611 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8612 @end example
8613
8614 to get access to the following facilities:
8615
8616 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8617 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8618 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8619 @end deffn
8620
8621 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8622 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8623 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8624 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8625 @end deffn
8626
8627 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8628 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8629 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8630 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8631 @end deffn
8632
8633 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8634 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8635 @end deffn
8636
8637 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8638 @cindex Firmware recovery
8639
8640 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8641 devices recovery with JTAG.
8642
8643 For quickstart instructions run:
8644 @example
8645 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8646 @end example
8647
8648 @node TFTP
8649 @chapter TFTP
8650 @cindex TFTP
8651 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8652 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8653
8654 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8655 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8656 server (tftpd). For example,
8657
8658 @example
8659 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8660 @end example
8661
8662 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8663 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8664
8665 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8666 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8667 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8668 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8669
8670 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8671 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8672 @cindex GDB
8673 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8674 to debug remote targets.
8675 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8676
8677 @itemize
8678 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8679 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8680 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8681 as shown in this chapter.
8682 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8683 that also will probably need to be configured.
8684 @end itemize
8685
8686 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8687 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8688 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8689 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8690 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8691 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8692
8693 @section Connecting to GDB
8694 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8695 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8696 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8697 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8698 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8699
8700 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8701
8702 @enumerate
8703 @item
8704 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8705 @example
8706 target remote localhost:3333
8707 @end example
8708 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8709
8710 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8711 @example
8712 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8713 @end example
8714 @item
8715 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8716 @example
8717 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8718 @end example
8719 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8720 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8721 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8722 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8723 @end enumerate
8724
8725 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8726 GDB command line.
8727
8728 @section Sample GDB session startup
8729
8730 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8731 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8732 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8733 small ARM program.
8734 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8735 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8736
8737 @example
8738 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8739 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8740 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8741 ...
8742 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8743 ...
8744 (gdb) load
8745 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8746 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8747 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8748 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8749 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8750 (gdb) continue
8751 Continuing.
8752 ...
8753 @end example
8754
8755 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8756 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8757 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8758 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8759
8760 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8761
8762 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8763 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8764 packet size and the device's memory map.
8765 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8766 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8767 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8768
8769 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8770 You may need to set those up by hand.
8771 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8772 something like:
8773
8774 @example
8775 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8776 @end example
8777
8778 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8779
8780 @example
8781 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8782 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8783 @end example
8784
8785 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8786 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8787 do not have such restrictions.
8788
8789 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8790 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8791 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8792
8793 @example
8794 define hook-step
8795 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8796 end
8797 define hookpost-step
8798 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8799 end
8800 @end example
8801
8802 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8803 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8804 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8805 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8806
8807 @section Programming using GDB
8808 @cindex Programming using GDB
8809 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8810
8811 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8812 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8813 @example
8814 gdb_memory_map disable
8815 @end example
8816 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8817 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8818 working area.
8819
8820 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8821 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8822 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8823 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8824
8825 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8826 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8827
8828 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8829 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8830 @example
8831 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8832 @end example
8833
8834 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8835 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8836
8837 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8838 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8839 will be used.
8840
8841 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8842 script can be executed:
8843 @example
8844 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8845 @end example
8846
8847 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8848 can be used.
8849 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8850 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8851 @cindex SMP
8852 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8853 @itemize @bullet
8854 @item j - smp status request
8855 @item J - smp set request
8856 @end itemize
8857
8858 OpenOCD implements :
8859 @itemize @bullet
8860 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8861 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8862 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8863 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8864 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8865 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8866 @end itemize
8867
8868 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8869 @itemize @bullet
8870 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8871 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8872 @example
8873 set $_core 1
8874 #Jc01 packet is sent
8875 print $_core
8876 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8877 @end example
8878
8879 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8880 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8881
8882 @example
8883 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8884 define toggle0
8885 maint packet Jc0
8886 continue
8887 main packet Jc-1
8888 end
8889 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8890 define toggle1
8891 maint packet Jc1
8892 continue
8893 main packet Jc-1
8894 end
8895 @end example
8896 @end itemize
8897
8898 @section RTOS Support
8899 @cindex RTOS Support
8900 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8901
8902 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8903 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8904
8905 @* An example setup is below:
8906
8907 @example
8908 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8909 @end example
8910
8911 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8912
8913 Currently supported rtos's include:
8914 @itemize @bullet
8915 @item @option{eCos}
8916 @item @option{ThreadX}
8917 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8918 @item @option{linux}
8919 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8920 @item @option{embKernel}
8921 @item @option{mqx}
8922 @end itemize
8923
8924 @quotation Note
8925 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8926 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8927 @end quotation
8928
8929 @table @code
8930 @item eCos symbols
8931 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8932 @item ThreadX symbols
8933 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8934 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8935 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
8936 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
8937 @tex
8938 \begingroup
8939 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
8940 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8941 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8942 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8943 \par
8944 \endgroup
8945 @end tex
8946 @item linux symbols
8947 init_task.
8948 @item ChibiOS symbols
8949 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8950 @item embKernel symbols
8951 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8952 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8953 @item mqx symbols
8954 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
8955 @end table
8956
8957 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8958 some, eg. FreeRTOS, extra steps must be taken.
8959
8960 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
8961 along with the project:
8962
8963 @table @code
8964 @item FreeRTOS
8965 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
8966 @end table
8967
8968 @node Tcl Scripting API
8969 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8970 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8971 @cindex Tcl scripts
8972 @section API rules
8973
8974 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8975 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8976 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8977
8978 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8979 pair list and lists.
8980
8981 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8982 list.
8983
8984 @example
8985 > set foo(me) Duane
8986 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8987 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8988 > set foo(duck) Donald
8989 @end example
8990
8991 If one does this:
8992
8993 @example
8994 > set foo
8995 @end example
8996
8997 The result is:
8998
8999 @example
9000 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
9001 @end example
9002
9003 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
9004
9005 @verbatim
9006 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
9007 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
9008 }
9009 @end verbatim
9010
9011 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
9012 should be passed in to the proc in question.
9013
9014 @section Internal low-level Commands
9015
9016 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
9017 invoke directly.
9018
9019 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
9020 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
9021 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
9022
9023 @itemize @bullet
9024 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
9025
9026 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
9027 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
9028
9029 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
9030 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
9031
9032 Return information about the flash banks
9033
9034 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
9035
9036 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
9037 its execution. Example:
9038
9039 @example
9040 > capture "reset init"
9041 @end example
9042
9043 @end itemize
9044
9045 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
9046 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
9047 called "flash_banks".
9048
9049 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
9050
9051 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
9052 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
9053 holds one of the following values:
9054
9055 @itemize @bullet
9056 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
9057 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
9058 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
9059 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
9060 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
9061 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
9062 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
9063 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
9064 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
9065 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
9066 @end itemize
9067
9068 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
9069
9070 @quotation Note
9071 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
9072 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
9073 @code{jim_platform} (because it
9074 is jim, not real tcl).
9075 @end quotation
9076
9077 @section Tcl RPC server
9078 @cindex RPC
9079
9080 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
9081 commands and receive the results.
9082
9083 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
9084 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
9085 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
9086 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
9087 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
9088
9089 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
9090 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
9091 @command{capture} command.
9092
9093 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
9094
9095 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
9096 @cindex RPC Notifications
9097
9098 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9099 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9100
9101 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
9102 in the following format.
9103
9104 @verbatim
9105 type target_event event [event-name]
9106 type target_state state [state-name]
9107 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
9108 @end verbatim
9109
9110 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
9111 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
9112 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9113 Defaults to off.
9114
9115 @end deffn
9116
9117 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
9118 @cindex RPC trace output
9119
9120 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9121 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9122
9123 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
9124
9125 @verbatim
9126 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
9127 @end verbatim
9128
9129 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
9130 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
9131 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9132 Defaults to off.
9133
9134 See an example application here:
9135 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
9136
9137 @end deffn
9138
9139 @node FAQ
9140 @chapter FAQ
9141 @cindex faq
9142 @enumerate
9143 @anchor{faqrtck}
9144 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
9145 @cindex RTCK
9146 @cindex adaptive clocking
9147 @*
9148
9149 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
9150 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
9151 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
9152 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
9153
9154 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
9155 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
9156 for example. There are 2 basic options:
9157 @enumerate
9158 @item
9159 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
9160 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
9161 @item
9162 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
9163 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
9164 @end enumerate
9165
9166 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
9167 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
9168 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
9169 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
9170 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
9171 power).
9172
9173 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
9174 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
9175 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
9176 ARM926 scenario).
9177 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
9178 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
9179 JTAG can use a faster clock.
9180
9181 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
9182 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
9183 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
9184 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
9185
9186 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
9187
9188 In order to make use of this,
9189 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
9190 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
9191
9192 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
9193 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
9194 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
9195 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
9196 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
9197
9198 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
9199 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
9200 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
9201 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
9202
9203 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
9204 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
9205 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
9206 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
9207 with a CPLD.
9208 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
9209 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
9210 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
9211 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
9212 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
9213 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
9214
9215 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
9216
9217 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
9218
9219 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
9220 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
9221 depending on the chips on your board.
9222 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
9223 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
9224 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
9225
9226 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
9227 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
9228 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
9229
9230 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
9231 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
9232 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
9233 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
9234
9235 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
9236 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
9237 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
9238 this way.
9239
9240 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
9241 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
9242 clock rate.
9243 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
9244 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
9245 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9246
9247 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
9248
9249 @example
9250 # Example: 1.234MHz
9251 adapter_khz 1234
9252 @end example
9253
9254
9255 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
9256
9257 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
9258 around Windows filenames.
9259
9260 @example
9261 > echo \a
9262
9263 > echo @{\a@}
9264 \a
9265 > echo "\a"
9266
9267 >
9268 @end example
9269
9270
9271 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
9272
9273 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
9274 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
9275 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
9276
9277 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
9278 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
9279 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
9280
9281 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
9282 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
9283 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
9284
9285 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
9286
9287 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
9288 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
9289 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
9290 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
9291
9292 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
9293 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
9294 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
9295
9296 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
9297 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
9298
9299 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
9300 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
9301 memory read caused data abort".
9302
9303 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
9304 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
9305 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
9306 be done, feel free to add this here.
9307
9308 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
9309 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
9310 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
9311 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
9312 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
9313 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
9314 gracefully stops.
9315
9316 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
9317 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
9318 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
9319
9320 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
9321 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
9322 bytes. Painful...
9323
9324
9325 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
9326 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
9327
9328 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
9329 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
9330 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
9331 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
9332 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
9333 reset, everything else should work fine.
9334
9335 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
9336 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
9337 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
9338 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
9339
9340 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
9341 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
9342 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
9343 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
9344
9345 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
9346
9347 @item @b{USB Power} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the
9348 following error messages: "Error: ft2232.c:201 ft2232_read(): FT_Read returned:
9349 4" and "Error: ft2232.c:365 ft2232_send_and_recv(): couldn't read from FT2232".
9350 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9351
9352 First of all, the reason might be the USB power supply. Try using a self-powered
9353 hub instead of a direct connection to your computer. Secondly, the error code 4
9354 corresponds to an FT_IO_ERROR, which means that the driver for the FTDI USB
9355 chip ran into some sort of error - this points us to a USB problem.
9356
9357 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
9358 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
9359 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9360
9361 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
9362 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
9363
9364 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
9365 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
9366 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
9367 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
9368 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
9369 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
9370 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
9371 clock frequency?
9372
9373 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
9374 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
9375 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
9376 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
9377 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
9378
9379 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
9380
9381 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
9382 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
9383 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
9384 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
9385 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
9386 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
9387 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
9388
9389 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
9390
9391 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
9392 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
9393 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
9394 up DRAM and loading it with code.
9395
9396 @anchor{faqtaporder}
9397 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
9398 particular order?
9399
9400 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
9401 the same order used by the hardware.
9402
9403 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
9404 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
9405 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
9406 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
9407 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
9408 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
9409
9410 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
9411 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
9412 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
9413 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
9414
9415 @itemize @bullet
9416 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
9417 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
9418 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
9419 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
9420 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
9421 @end itemize
9422
9423 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
9424
9425 @itemize @bullet
9426 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
9427 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
9428 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
9429 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
9430 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
9431 @end itemize
9432
9433
9434 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
9435 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
9436 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
9437
9438 TODO.
9439
9440 @end enumerate
9441
9442 @node Tcl Crash Course
9443 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
9444 @cindex Tcl
9445
9446 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
9447 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
9448 how the Tcl scripts work.
9449
9450 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
9451 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
9452 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
9453 OpenOCD.
9454
9455 @section Tcl Rule #1
9456 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
9457 @enumerate
9458 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
9459 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9460 @end enumerate
9461
9462 The Tcl equal is this:
9463
9464 @enumerate
9465 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
9466 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9467 @end enumerate
9468
9469 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
9470 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
9471
9472 @section Tcl Rule #1b
9473 There is a second pair of rules.
9474 @enumerate
9475 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
9476 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
9477 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
9478 in Tcl.
9479 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9480 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
9481 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
9482 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
9483 @end enumerate
9484
9485 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
9486 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
9487 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
9488 Everything is a string}
9489
9490 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
9491 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
9492 difference is subtle.
9493 @enumerate
9494 @item Parse Time
9495 @item Evaluation Time
9496 @end enumerate
9497
9498 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
9499 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
9500 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
9501
9502 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
9503 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
9504 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
9505 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
9506
9507 @itemize @bullet
9508 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
9509 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
9510 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9511 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9512 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9513 @example
9514 # bash example
9515 X=`date`
9516 echo "The Date is: $X"
9517 # Tcl example
9518 set X [date]
9519 puts "The Date is: $X"
9520 @end example
9521 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9522 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9523 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9524 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9525 is a string}
9526 @example
9527 set x "Dinner"
9528 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9529 @end example
9530 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9531 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9532 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9533 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9534 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9535 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9536 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9537 @end itemize
9538
9539 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9540
9541 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9542
9543 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9544
9545 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9546 the normal way.
9547
9548 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9549 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9550 line is immedatly executed.
9551
9552 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9553 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9554
9555 @subsection Command Execution
9556
9557 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9558 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9559 control flow operators.
9560
9561 Commands are executed like this:
9562
9563 @enumerate
9564 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9565 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9566 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9567 @end enumerate
9568
9569 It sort of works like this:
9570 @example
9571 for(;;)@{
9572 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9573
9574 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9575
9576 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9577 @}
9578 @end example
9579
9580 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9581 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9582 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9583 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9584 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9585 ``LookupCommand()''
9586
9587 @subsection The FOR command
9588
9589 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9590 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9591 command just like any other command.
9592
9593 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9594 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9595 are:
9596
9597 @enumerate 0
9598 @item The ascii text 'for'
9599 @item The start text
9600 @item The test expression
9601 @item The next text
9602 @item The body text
9603 @end enumerate
9604
9605 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9606 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9607 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9608 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9609
9610 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9611 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9612
9613 @example
9614 int
9615 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9616 int *argc,
9617 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9618 @end example
9619
9620 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9621 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9622 still operates in the same basic way.
9623
9624 @subsection FOR command implementation
9625
9626 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9627 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9628
9629 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9630
9631 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9632
9633 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9634 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9635 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9636
9637 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9638 expression and returns a value.
9639
9640 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9641 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9642 @example
9643 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9644
9645 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9646
9647 int
9648 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9649 int argc,
9650 char **argv )
9651 @{
9652 if( argc != 5 )@{
9653 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9654 return ERROR;
9655 @}
9656
9657 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9658
9659 // Execute the start statement.
9660 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9661
9662 // Top of loop test
9663 for(;;)@{
9664 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9665 if( i == 0 )
9666 break;
9667
9668 // Execute the body
9669 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9670
9671 // Execute the LOOP part
9672 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9673 @}
9674
9675 // Return no error
9676 SetResult( interp, "" );
9677 return SUCCESS;
9678 @}
9679 @end example
9680
9681 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9682 in the same basic way.
9683
9684 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9685
9686 @subsection source and find commands
9687 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9688 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9689 @*Remember the parsing rules
9690 @enumerate
9691 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9692 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9693 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9694 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9695 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9696 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9697 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9698 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9699 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9700 @end enumerate
9701 @subsection format command
9702 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9703 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9704 @b{sprintf()}.
9705 @b{Example}
9706 @example
9707 set x 6
9708 set y 7
9709 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9710 @end example
9711 @enumerate
9712 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9713 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9714 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9715 @* Refer to Rule #1
9716 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9717 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9718 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9719 @end enumerate
9720 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9721 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9722 @example
9723 #1 Good
9724 proc someproc @{@} @{
9725 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9726 @}
9727 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9728 #2 Good - no variables
9729 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9730 #3 Good Curly Braces
9731 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9732 puts "Time: [date]"
9733 @}
9734 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9735 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9736 @end example
9737 @enumerate
9738 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9739 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9740 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9741 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9742 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9743 command.
9744 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9745 @*There are 4 examples:
9746 @enumerate
9747 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9748 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9749 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9750 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9751 @end enumerate
9752
9753 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9754 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9755 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9756
9757 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9758 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9759 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9760 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9761 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9762 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9763 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9764 @end enumerate
9765 @subsection Global Variables
9766 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9767 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9768 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9769 @example
9770 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9771 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9772 global x #Global variable X
9773 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9774 @}
9775 @end example
9776 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9777 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9778 @example
9779 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9780 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9781 # Create var name
9782 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9783 # Make it a global
9784 global $vn
9785 # Set it.
9786 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9787 @}
9788 @end example
9789 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9790 @example
9791 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9792 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9793 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9794 @}
9795 @end example
9796
9797 @include fdl.texi
9798
9799 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9800 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9801 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9802 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9803 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9804 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9805
9806 @printindex cp
9807
9808 @node Command and Driver Index
9809 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9810 @printindex fn
9811
9812 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)